1 | % Conventions: uncross-referenced entries appear first, then |
---|
2 | % cross-referenced entries. In both groups, entries are sorted by their |
---|
3 | % title field. Lines like "% A" exist to speed searches. The main |
---|
4 | % paper on a language uses the language name as the citation key. Other |
---|
5 | % papers use ``<language name>:'' as a prefix. Please consider leaving |
---|
6 | % keyword lists and an abstract or comment for future generations, and |
---|
7 | % put some identification in a contributer field. |
---|
8 | |
---|
9 | % Predefined journal names: |
---|
10 | % acmcs: Computing Surveys acta: Acta Infomatica |
---|
11 | % cacm: Communications of the ACM |
---|
12 | % ibmjrd: IBM J. Research & Development ibmsj: IBM Systems Journal |
---|
13 | % ieeese: IEEE Trans. on Soft. Eng. ieeetc: IEEE Trans. on Computers |
---|
14 | % ieeetcad: IEEE Trans. on Computer-Aided Design of Integrated Circuits |
---|
15 | % ipl: Information Processing Letters jacm: Journal of the ACM |
---|
16 | % jcss: J. Computer & System Sciences scp: Science of Comp. Programming |
---|
17 | % sicomp: SIAM J. on Computing tocs: ACM Trans. on Comp. Systems |
---|
18 | % tods: ACM Trans. on Database Sys. tog: ACM Trans. on Graphics |
---|
19 | % toms: ACM Trans. on Math. Software toois: ACM Trans. on Office Info. Sys. |
---|
20 | % toplas: ACM Trans. on Prog. Lang. & Sys. |
---|
21 | % tcs: Theoretical Computer Science |
---|
22 | @string{ieeepds="IEEE Transactions on Parallel and Distributed Systems"} |
---|
23 | % @string{ieeepds="IEEE Trans. Parallel Distrib. Syst."} |
---|
24 | @string{ieeese="IEEE Transactions on Software Engineering"} |
---|
25 | % @string{ieeese="IEEE Trans. Softw. Eng."} |
---|
26 | @string{spe="Software---\-Practice and Experience"} |
---|
27 | % @string{spe="Softw. Pract. Exp."} |
---|
28 | @string{ccpe="Concurrency and Computation: Practice and Experience"} |
---|
29 | % @string{ccpe="Concurrency Comput. Pract. Exp."} |
---|
30 | @string{sigplan="SIGPLAN Notices"} |
---|
31 | % @string{sigplan="SIGPLAN Not."} |
---|
32 | @string{joop="Journal of Object-Oriented Programming"} |
---|
33 | % @string{joop="J. of Object-Oriented Program."} |
---|
34 | @string{popl="Conference Record of the ACM Symposium on Principles of Programming Languages"} |
---|
35 | @string{osr="Operating Systems Review"} |
---|
36 | @string{pldi="Programming Language Design and Implementation"} |
---|
37 | @string{mathann="Mathematische Annalen"} |
---|
38 | % @string{mathann="Math. Ann."} |
---|
39 | |
---|
40 | % A |
---|
41 | |
---|
42 | @incollection{ABC++, |
---|
43 | keywords = {concurrency, parallel, distributed, C++}, |
---|
44 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
45 | author = {William G. O'Farrell and Frank Ch. Eigler and S. David Pullara and Gregory V. Wilson }, |
---|
46 | title = {{ABC}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
47 | editor = {Gregory V. Wilson and Paul Lu}, |
---|
48 | booktitle = {Parallel Programming in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
49 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
50 | address = {New York}, |
---|
51 | series = {Scientific and Engineering Computation Series}, |
---|
52 | year = 1996, |
---|
53 | pages = {1-42}, |
---|
54 | } |
---|
55 | |
---|
56 | @techreport{CL90abstract, |
---|
57 | keywords = {}, |
---|
58 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
59 | author = {Luca Cardelli and Xavier Leroy}, |
---|
60 | title = {Abstract Types and the Dot Notation}, |
---|
61 | institution = {Systems Research Center}, |
---|
62 | year = 1990, |
---|
63 | address = {130 Lytton Avenue, Palo Alto, CA 94301}, |
---|
64 | number = 56, |
---|
65 | summary = { |
---|
66 | The existential types of Mitchell and Plotkin \cite{atet} model |
---|
67 | abstract types, but their ``open'' notation is unlike the usual dot |
---|
68 | notation used in programming languages. This paper gives |
---|
69 | translations between the ``open'' and ``dot'' forms, and suggests |
---|
70 | extensions for nested and for parameterized abstractions. |
---|
71 | } |
---|
72 | } |
---|
73 | |
---|
74 | @article{atet, |
---|
75 | keywords = {lambda calculus, polymorphism}, |
---|
76 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
77 | author = {John C. Mitchell and Gordon D. Plotkin}, |
---|
78 | title = {Abstract Types have Existential Type}, |
---|
79 | journal = toplas, |
---|
80 | year = 1988, |
---|
81 | month = jul, volume = 10, number = 3, pages = {470-502}, |
---|
82 | abstract = { |
---|
83 | Abstract data type declarations appear in typed programming |
---|
84 | languages like Ada, Alphard, CLU and ML. This form of declaration |
---|
85 | binds a list of identifiers to a type with associated operations, a |
---|
86 | composite ``value'' we call a {\em data algebra}. We use a |
---|
87 | second-order typed lambda calculus SOL to show how data algebras |
---|
88 | may be given types, passed as parameters, and returned as results of |
---|
89 | function calls. In the process, we discuss the semantics of |
---|
90 | abstract data type declarations and review a connection between |
---|
91 | typed programming languages and constructive logic. |
---|
92 | } |
---|
93 | } |
---|
94 | |
---|
95 | @article{alphard:intro, |
---|
96 | keywords = {encapsulation, data abstraction}, |
---|
97 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
98 | author = {Wm. A. Wulf and Ralph L. London and Mary Shaw}, |
---|
99 | title = {Abstraction and Verification in Alphard: Introduction to Language and Methodology}, |
---|
100 | journal = ieeese, |
---|
101 | year = 1976, |
---|
102 | month = dec, volume = {SE-2}, number = 4, pages = {253-265}, |
---|
103 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{alphard}.}, |
---|
104 | abstract = { |
---|
105 | Alphard is a programming language whose goals include supporting |
---|
106 | both the development of well-structured programs and the formal |
---|
107 | verification of these programs. This paper attempts to capture the |
---|
108 | symbiotic influence of these two goals on the design of the |
---|
109 | language. To that end the language description is interleaved with |
---|
110 | the presentation of a proof technique and discudssion of |
---|
111 | programming methodology. Examples to illustrate both the language |
---|
112 | and the verification technique are included. |
---|
113 | } |
---|
114 | } |
---|
115 | |
---|
116 | @book{Hilfinger83, |
---|
117 | keywords = {ada}, |
---|
118 | author = {Paul N. Hilfinger}, |
---|
119 | title = {Abstraction Mechanisms and Language Design}, |
---|
120 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
121 | series = {ACM Distinguished Dissertations}, |
---|
122 | year = 1983, |
---|
123 | } |
---|
124 | |
---|
125 | @incollection{Lavender96, |
---|
126 | author = {R. Greg Lavender and Douglas C. Schmidt}, |
---|
127 | chapter = {Active Object: An Object Behavioral Pattern for Concurrent Programming}, |
---|
128 | title = {Pattern Languages of Program Design 2}, |
---|
129 | editor = {John M. Vlissides and James O. Coplien and Norman L. Kerth}, |
---|
130 | year = 1996, |
---|
131 | pages = {483-499}, |
---|
132 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley Longman Publishing}, |
---|
133 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
134 | } |
---|
135 | |
---|
136 | @article{Nierstrasz87, |
---|
137 | keywords = {Hybrid, active objects, object-oriented languages, |
---|
138 | object-based languages, delegation, concurrency}, |
---|
139 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
140 | author = {O. M. Nierstrasz}, |
---|
141 | title = {Active Objects in {Hybrid}}, |
---|
142 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
143 | volume = 22, |
---|
144 | number = 12, |
---|
145 | month = dec, |
---|
146 | year = 1987, |
---|
147 | pages = {243-253}, |
---|
148 | note = {Proceedings of the OOPSLA'87 Conference, Oct. 4--8, 1987, Orlando, Florida}, |
---|
149 | abstract = { |
---|
150 | Most object-oriented languages are strong on reusability or on |
---|
151 | strong-typing, but weak on concurrency. In response to this gap, |
---|
152 | we are developing {\it Hybrid}, an object-oriented language in which |
---|
153 | objects are the active entities. Objects in Hybrid are organized |
---|
154 | into {\it domains}, and concurrent executions into {\it activities}. |
---|
155 | All object communications are based on remote procedure calls. |
---|
156 | Unstructured {\it sends\/} and {\it accepts\/} are forbidden. To |
---|
157 | this the mechanisms of {\it delegation\/} and {\it delay queues\/} |
---|
158 | are added to enable switching and triggering of activities. |
---|
159 | Concurrent subactivities and atomic actions are provided for |
---|
160 | compactness and simplicity. We show how solutions to many important |
---|
161 | concurrent problems [sic], such as pipelining, constraint management |
---|
162 | and ``administration'' can be compactly expressed using these |
---|
163 | mechanisms. |
---|
164 | }, |
---|
165 | comment = {Mentions Thoth in reference to delegation} |
---|
166 | } |
---|
167 | |
---|
168 | @book{Actors, |
---|
169 | keywords = {actors, concurrency}, |
---|
170 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
171 | author = {Gul A. Agha}, |
---|
172 | title = {Actors: A Model of Concurrent Computation in Distributed Systems}, |
---|
173 | publisher = {MIT Press, Cambridge}, |
---|
174 | year = 1986 |
---|
175 | } |
---|
176 | |
---|
177 | @article{polymorphImpl, |
---|
178 | keywords = {Napier88}, |
---|
179 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
180 | author = {R. Morrison and A. Dearle and R. C. H. Connor and A. L. Brown}, |
---|
181 | title = {An Ad Hoc Approach to the Implementation of Polymorphism}, |
---|
182 | journal = toplas, |
---|
183 | year = 1991, |
---|
184 | month = jul, |
---|
185 | volume = 13, |
---|
186 | number = 3, |
---|
187 | pages = {342-371}, |
---|
188 | abstract = { |
---|
189 | Polymorphic abstraction provides the ability to write programs that |
---|
190 | are independent of the form of the data over which they operate. |
---|
191 | There are a number of different categories of polymorphic |
---|
192 | expression---ad hoc and universal, which includes parametric and |
---|
193 | inclusion---all of which have many advantages in terms of code |
---|
194 | reuse and software economics. It has proved difficult to provide |
---|
195 | efficient implementations of polymorphism. Here, we address this |
---|
196 | problem and describe a new technique that can implement all forms |
---|
197 | of polymorphism, use a conventional machine architecture, and |
---|
198 | support nonuniform data representations. Furthermore, the method |
---|
199 | ensures that any extra cost of implementation applies to |
---|
200 | polymorphic forms only, and allows such polymorphic forms to |
---|
201 | persist over program invocations. |
---|
202 | }, |
---|
203 | summary = { |
---|
204 | They give three ways to implement polymorphism: {\em textual |
---|
205 | polymorphism}, which seems to be template instantiation, {\em |
---|
206 | uniform polymorphism}, which they explain badly, and {\em tagged |
---|
207 | polymorphism}, where object code performs type tests. |
---|
208 | |
---|
209 | They use first-class procedures to implement polymorphism: routines |
---|
210 | with type parameters are implemented as curried routines that |
---|
211 | return a nested routine that refers to the type parameter. |
---|
212 | } |
---|
213 | } |
---|
214 | |
---|
215 | @article{dim:ada, |
---|
216 | keywords = {Dimensional Analysis, Ada}, |
---|
217 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
218 | author = {Paul N. Hilfinger}, |
---|
219 | title = {An {Ada} Package for Dimensional Analysis}, |
---|
220 | journal = toplas, |
---|
221 | month = apr, |
---|
222 | year = 1988, |
---|
223 | volume = 10, |
---|
224 | number = 2, |
---|
225 | pages = {189-203}, |
---|
226 | } |
---|
227 | |
---|
228 | @mastersthesis{Younger91, |
---|
229 | keywords = {concurrency, C++, postponing requests}, |
---|
230 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
231 | author = {Brian M. Younger}, |
---|
232 | title = {Adding Concurrency to {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
233 | school = {University of Waterloo}, |
---|
234 | year = 1991, |
---|
235 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
236 | } |
---|
237 | |
---|
238 | @inproceedings{Buhr92c, |
---|
239 | keywords = {concurrency}, |
---|
240 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
241 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Glen Ditchfield}, |
---|
242 | title = {Adding Concurrency to a Programming Language}, |
---|
243 | booktitle = {USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Technical Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
244 | organization= {USENIX Association}, |
---|
245 | address = {Portland, Oregon, U.S.A.}, |
---|
246 | month = aug, |
---|
247 | year = 1992, |
---|
248 | pages = {207-224}, |
---|
249 | } |
---|
250 | |
---|
251 | @article{Buhr89b, |
---|
252 | keywords = {concurrency, C++}, |
---|
253 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
254 | author = {P. A. Buhr and Glen Ditchfield and C. R. Zarnke}, |
---|
255 | title = {Adding Concurrency to a Statically Type-Safe Object-Oriented Programming Language}, |
---|
256 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
257 | volume = 24, |
---|
258 | number = 4, |
---|
259 | month = apr, |
---|
260 | year = 1989, |
---|
261 | pages = {18-21}, |
---|
262 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN Workshop on Object-Based Concurrent Programming, Sept. 26--27, 1988, San Diego, California, U.S.A.}, |
---|
263 | } |
---|
264 | |
---|
265 | @article{Knuth66, |
---|
266 | keywords = {N-thread software-solution mutual exclusion}, |
---|
267 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
268 | author = {Donald E. Knuth}, |
---|
269 | title = {Additional Comments on a Problem in Concurrent Programming Control}, |
---|
270 | journal = cacm, |
---|
271 | month = may, |
---|
272 | year = 1966, |
---|
273 | volume = 9, |
---|
274 | number = 5, |
---|
275 | pages = {321-322}, |
---|
276 | note = {Letter to the Editor} |
---|
277 | } |
---|
278 | |
---|
279 | @article{DeBruijn67, |
---|
280 | keywords = {N-thread software-solution mutual exclusion}, |
---|
281 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
282 | author = {Nicolaas Govert de Bruijn}, |
---|
283 | title = {Additional Comments on a Problem in Concurrent Programming Control}, |
---|
284 | journal = cacm, |
---|
285 | month = mar, |
---|
286 | year = 1967, |
---|
287 | volume = 10, |
---|
288 | number = 3, |
---|
289 | pages = {137-138}, |
---|
290 | note = {letter to the Editor} |
---|
291 | } |
---|
292 | |
---|
293 | @phdthesis{Krischer10, |
---|
294 | author = {Roy Krischer}, |
---|
295 | title = {Advanced Concepts in Asynchronous Exception Handling}, |
---|
296 | school = {University of Waterloo}, |
---|
297 | year = 2010, |
---|
298 | month = dec, |
---|
299 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
300 | optnote = {\textsf{http://uwspace.uwaterloo.ca/\-bitstream/10012/\-5751\-/1/Krischer\_Roy.pdf}}, |
---|
301 | note = {\href{http://uwspace.uwaterloo.ca/bitstream/10012/5751/1/Krischer_Roy.pdf}{http://uwspace.uwaterloo.ca/\-bitstream/10012/\-5751\-/1/Krischer\_Roy.pdf}}, |
---|
302 | } |
---|
303 | |
---|
304 | @article{Buhr00a, |
---|
305 | keywords = {exception handling}, |
---|
306 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
307 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and W. Y. Russell Mok}, |
---|
308 | title = {Advanced Exception Handling Mechanisms}, |
---|
309 | journal = ieeese, |
---|
310 | volume = 26, |
---|
311 | number = 9, |
---|
312 | month = sep, |
---|
313 | year = 2000, |
---|
314 | pages = {820-836}, |
---|
315 | } |
---|
316 | |
---|
317 | @book{Richter97, |
---|
318 | keywords = {Win32, threads}, |
---|
319 | author = {Jeffrey M. Richter}, |
---|
320 | title = {Advanced Windows}, |
---|
321 | publisher = {Microsoft Press}, |
---|
322 | year = 1997, |
---|
323 | edition = {3rd}, |
---|
324 | } |
---|
325 | |
---|
326 | @article{Francez77, |
---|
327 | keywords = {parameter passing, named/positional arguments}, |
---|
328 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
329 | author = {Nissim Francez}, |
---|
330 | title = {Another Advantage of Key word Notation for Parameter Communication with Subprograms}, |
---|
331 | journal = cacm, |
---|
332 | volume = 20, |
---|
333 | number = 8, |
---|
334 | month = aug, |
---|
335 | year = 1977, |
---|
336 | pages = {604-605}, |
---|
337 | } |
---|
338 | |
---|
339 | @manual{Akka, |
---|
340 | keywords = {Akka actor model}, |
---|
341 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
342 | title = {{A}kka {S}cala Documentation, Release 2.4.11}, |
---|
343 | organization= {Lightbend Inc.}, |
---|
344 | month = sep, |
---|
345 | year = 2016, |
---|
346 | note = {\href{http://doc.akka.io/docs/akka/2.4/AkkaScala.pdf}{http://\-doc.akka.io/\-docs/\-akka/\-2.4/\-AkkaScala.pdf}}, |
---|
347 | } |
---|
348 | |
---|
349 | @article{Algol60, |
---|
350 | keywords = {Algol60}, |
---|
351 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
352 | author = {J. W. Backus and F. L. Bauer and J. Green and C. Katz and |
---|
353 | J. McCarthy and P. Naur and A. J. Perlis and H. Rutishauser and K. Samuelson |
---|
354 | and B. Vauquois and J.H. Wegstein and A. van Wijngaarden and M. Woodger}, |
---|
355 | title = {Revised Report on the Algorithmic Language Algol 60}, |
---|
356 | editor = {Peter Nauer}, |
---|
357 | journal = cacm, |
---|
358 | volume = 6, |
---|
359 | number = 1, |
---|
360 | month = jan, |
---|
361 | year = 1963, |
---|
362 | pages = {1-17}, |
---|
363 | } |
---|
364 | |
---|
365 | @article{Mellor-Crummey91, |
---|
366 | keywords = {spin locks, compare-and-swap, barriers}, |
---|
367 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
368 | author = {John M. Mellor-Crummey and Michael L. Scott}, |
---|
369 | title = {Algorithm for Scalable Synchronization on Shared-Memory Multiprocessors}, |
---|
370 | journal = tocs, |
---|
371 | volume = 9, |
---|
372 | number = 1, |
---|
373 | month = feb, |
---|
374 | year = 1991, |
---|
375 | pages = {21-65}, |
---|
376 | } |
---|
377 | |
---|
378 | @article{Cormack81, |
---|
379 | keywords = {}, |
---|
380 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
381 | author = {Gordon V. Cormack}, |
---|
382 | title = {An Algorithm for the Selection of Overloaded Functions in {Ada}}, |
---|
383 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
384 | year = 1981, |
---|
385 | month = feb, volume = 16, number = 2, pages = {48-52}, |
---|
386 | comment = { |
---|
387 | A one-pass, top-down algorithm for overload resolution. Input is a |
---|
388 | parse tree and the desired result type, and output is the number of |
---|
389 | solutions. For each overloading of the root identifier with a |
---|
390 | matching parameter list, recursively solve for each parameter for |
---|
391 | the corresponding argument type---there should be one solution. |
---|
392 | } |
---|
393 | } |
---|
394 | |
---|
395 | @book{Raynal86, |
---|
396 | keywords = {mutual exclusion, locks}, |
---|
397 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
398 | author = {M. Raynal}, |
---|
399 | title = {Algorithms for Mutual Exclusion}, |
---|
400 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
401 | address = {Cambridge}, |
---|
402 | series = {Scientific Computation Series}, |
---|
403 | year = 1986, |
---|
404 | note = {Translated by D. Beeson}, |
---|
405 | } |
---|
406 | |
---|
407 | @incollection{Gidenstam05, |
---|
408 | keywords = {lock free, dynamic memory allocation}, |
---|
409 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
410 | author = {Anders Gidenstam and Marina Papatriantafilou and Philippas Tsigas}, |
---|
411 | title = {Allocating Memory in a Lock-free Manner}, |
---|
412 | editor = {Gerth St{\o}lting Brodal and Stefano Leonardi}, |
---|
413 | booktitle = {Algorithms -- ESA 2005}, |
---|
414 | pages = {329-342}, |
---|
415 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
416 | address = {New York}, |
---|
417 | year = 2005, |
---|
418 | volume = 3669, |
---|
419 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science}, |
---|
420 | } |
---|
421 | |
---|
422 | @book{Sites92, |
---|
423 | keywords = {computers, Alpha}, |
---|
424 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
425 | editor = {Richard L. Sites}, |
---|
426 | title = {Alpha Architecture Reference Manual}, |
---|
427 | publisher = {Digital Press, Burlington}, |
---|
428 | year = 1992, |
---|
429 | } |
---|
430 | |
---|
431 | @book{alphard, |
---|
432 | keywords = {Parametric polymorphism, alphard, iterators, nested types}, |
---|
433 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
434 | editor = {Mary Shaw}, |
---|
435 | title = {{ALPHARD}: Form and Content}, |
---|
436 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
437 | address = {New York}, |
---|
438 | year = 1981, |
---|
439 | comment = {Collection of papers about Alphard.} |
---|
440 | } |
---|
441 | |
---|
442 | @article{Kessels77, |
---|
443 | keywords = {monitors}, |
---|
444 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
445 | author = {Joep L. W. Kessels}, |
---|
446 | title = {An Alternative to Event Queues for Synchronization in Monitors}, |
---|
447 | journal = cacm, |
---|
448 | volume = 20, |
---|
449 | number = 7, |
---|
450 | month = jul, |
---|
451 | year = 1977, |
---|
452 | pages = {500-503}, |
---|
453 | annote = { |
---|
454 | } |
---|
455 | } |
---|
456 | |
---|
457 | @article{descr, |
---|
458 | keywords = {X2, subclasses, inheritance, parameterized classes}, |
---|
459 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
460 | author = {David Sandberg}, |
---|
461 | title = {An Alternative to Subclassing}, |
---|
462 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
463 | volume = {21}, number = {11}, |
---|
464 | pages = {424-428}, |
---|
465 | month = nov, year = 1986, |
---|
466 | comment = { |
---|
467 | The Smalltalk class hierarchy has three uses: factoring out code; |
---|
468 | ``Abstraction superclasses'' such as Collection; rapid construction |
---|
469 | of new classes by incremental change. |
---|
470 | |
---|
471 | ``A descriptive class specifies a partial behavior by specifying a |
---|
472 | set of procedure headings that describe what can be done with |
---|
473 | instances of classes that belong to the descriptive class.'' An |
---|
474 | ``instance'' statement declares a class to be an instance of a |
---|
475 | descriptive class and defines the correspondence between |
---|
476 | operations. Procedures with descriptive class parameters take any |
---|
477 | instance as arguments. Descriptive classes can describe relations |
---|
478 | like ``c is a collection with element type e'', but how such things |
---|
479 | are used isn't explained. |
---|
480 | |
---|
481 | For each descriptive class used in a parameter list, an implicit |
---|
482 | parameter is created that is passed a vector of procedures. |
---|
483 | } |
---|
484 | } |
---|
485 | |
---|
486 | @incollection{Matsuoka93, |
---|
487 | keywords = {inheritance anomaly}, |
---|
488 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
489 | author = {Satoshi Matsuoka and Akinori Yonezawa}, |
---|
490 | title = {Analysis of Inheritance Anomaly in Object-Oriented Concurrent Programming Languages}, |
---|
491 | booktitle = {Research Directions in Concurrent Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
492 | editor = {Gul Agha and Peter Wegner and Akinori Yonezawa}, |
---|
493 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
494 | address = {New York}, |
---|
495 | year = 1993, |
---|
496 | pages = {107-150}, |
---|
497 | } |
---|
498 | |
---|
499 | @article{Sinha00, |
---|
500 | author = {Saurabh Sinha and Mary Jean Harrold}, |
---|
501 | title = {Analysis and Testing of Programs with Exception-Handling Constructs}, |
---|
502 | journal = ieeese, |
---|
503 | year = 2000, |
---|
504 | month = sep, |
---|
505 | volume = 26, |
---|
506 | number = 9, |
---|
507 | pages = {849--871}, |
---|
508 | } |
---|
509 | |
---|
510 | @inproceedings{Robillard99, |
---|
511 | author = {Martin P. Robillard and Gail C. Murphy}, |
---|
512 | title = {Analyzing Exception Flow in {J}ava Programs}, |
---|
513 | booktitle = {ESEC/FSE-7: Proceedings of the 7th European Software Engineering Conference held jointly |
---|
514 | with the 7th ACM SIGSOFT International Symposium on Foundations of Software Engineering}, |
---|
515 | year = 1999, |
---|
516 | pages = {322--337}, |
---|
517 | isbn = {3-540-66538-2}, |
---|
518 | location = {Toulouse, France}, |
---|
519 | doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/318773.319251}, |
---|
520 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
521 | address = {London, UK}, |
---|
522 | } |
---|
523 | |
---|
524 | @book{C++, |
---|
525 | keywords = {C++, ANSI}, |
---|
526 | author = {Margaret A. Ellis and Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
527 | title = {The Annotated {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Reference Manual}, |
---|
528 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
529 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
530 | year = 1990, |
---|
531 | edition = {1st}, |
---|
532 | } |
---|
533 | |
---|
534 | @book{APL, |
---|
535 | keywords = {APL}, |
---|
536 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
537 | author = {K. E. Iverson}, |
---|
538 | title = {A Programming Language}, |
---|
539 | publisher = {Wiley, New York}, |
---|
540 | year = 1962 |
---|
541 | } |
---|
542 | |
---|
543 | @article{PS-Algol:old, |
---|
544 | author = {M. Atkinson and P. Bailey and K. Chisholm and P. Cockshott and R. Morrison}, |
---|
545 | title = {An Approach to Persistent Programming}, |
---|
546 | journal = {The Computer Journal}, |
---|
547 | year = 1983, |
---|
548 | volume = 26, |
---|
549 | number = 4, |
---|
550 | pages = {360-365}, |
---|
551 | } |
---|
552 | |
---|
553 | @article{Kessels82, |
---|
554 | keywords = {concurrency, critical section}, |
---|
555 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
556 | author = {Joep L. W. Kessels}, |
---|
557 | title = {Arbitration Without Common Modifiable Variables}, |
---|
558 | journal = acta, |
---|
559 | volume = 17, |
---|
560 | number = 2, |
---|
561 | month = jun, |
---|
562 | year = 1982, |
---|
563 | pages = {135-141}, |
---|
564 | } |
---|
565 | |
---|
566 | @article{Buhr95a, |
---|
567 | keywords = {concurrency, library approach}, |
---|
568 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
569 | author = {Peter A. Buhr}, |
---|
570 | title = {Are Safe Concurrency Libraries Possible?}, |
---|
571 | journal = cacm, |
---|
572 | month = feb, |
---|
573 | year = 1995, |
---|
574 | volume = 38, |
---|
575 | number = 2, |
---|
576 | pages = {117-120}, |
---|
577 | } |
---|
578 | |
---|
579 | @book{ARMv7, |
---|
580 | key = {ARM processor}, |
---|
581 | title = {ARM Architecture Reference Manual}, |
---|
582 | publisher = {ARM}, |
---|
583 | volume = {ARM DDI 0406C.b (ID072512)}, |
---|
584 | year = 2012, |
---|
585 | } |
---|
586 | |
---|
587 | @book{Herlihy08, |
---|
588 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
589 | author = {Herlihy, Maurice and Shavit, Nir}, |
---|
590 | title = {The Art of Multiprocessor Programming}, |
---|
591 | year = 2008, |
---|
592 | isbn = {0123705916, 9780123705914}, |
---|
593 | publisher = {Morgan Kaufmann Publishers}, |
---|
594 | address = {San Francisco}, |
---|
595 | } |
---|
596 | |
---|
597 | @inproceedings{Chung10, |
---|
598 | keywords = {transactional memory, lock-free programming, x86 architecture}, |
---|
599 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
600 | author = {Jaewoong Chung and Luke Yen and Stephan Diestelhorst and Martin Pohlack and Michael Hohmuth and David Christie and Dan Grossman}, |
---|
601 | title = {ASF: AMD64 Extension for Lock-Free Data Structures and Transactional Memory}, |
---|
602 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 2010 43rd Annual IEEE/ACM International Symposium on Microarchitecture}, |
---|
603 | series = {MICRO '43}, |
---|
604 | year = 2010, |
---|
605 | pages = {39--50}, |
---|
606 | numpages = {12}, |
---|
607 | publisher = {IEEE Computer Society}, |
---|
608 | address = {Washington, DC, USA}, |
---|
609 | } |
---|
610 | |
---|
611 | @article{Buhr94a, |
---|
612 | keywords = {assignment, parameter passing, multiple assignment}, |
---|
613 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
614 | author = {P. A. Buhr and David Till and C. R. Zarnke}, |
---|
615 | title = {Assignment as the Sole Means of Updating Objects}, |
---|
616 | journal = spe, |
---|
617 | month = sep, |
---|
618 | year = 1994, |
---|
619 | volume = 24, |
---|
620 | number = 9, |
---|
621 | pages = {835-870}, |
---|
622 | } |
---|
623 | |
---|
624 | @inproceedings{Krischer08, |
---|
625 | keywords = {exception handling, asynchronous, blocked tasks}, |
---|
626 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
627 | author = {Roy Krischer and Peter A. Buhr}, |
---|
628 | title = {Asynchronous Exception Propagation in Blocked Tasks}, |
---|
629 | booktitle = {4th International Workshop on Exception Handling (WEH.08)}, |
---|
630 | organization= {16th International Symposium on the Foundations of Software Engineering (FSE 16)}, |
---|
631 | address = {Atlanta, U.S.A}, |
---|
632 | month = nov, |
---|
633 | year = 2008, |
---|
634 | pages = {8-15}, |
---|
635 | } |
---|
636 | |
---|
637 | @article{oop:modpascal, |
---|
638 | keywords = {ModPascal}, |
---|
639 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
640 | author = {Walter G. Olthoff}, |
---|
641 | title = {Augmentation of Object-Oriented Programming by Concepts of Abstract Data Type Theory: The ModPascal Experience}, |
---|
642 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
643 | volume = 21, |
---|
644 | number = 11, |
---|
645 | pages = {429-443}, |
---|
646 | month = nov, |
---|
647 | year = 1986 |
---|
648 | } |
---|
649 | |
---|
650 | @inproceedings{Shen91, |
---|
651 | keywords = {Ada, polymorphism}, |
---|
652 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
653 | author = {Jun Shen and Gordon V. Cormack}, |
---|
654 | title = {Automatic instantiation in Ada}, |
---|
655 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the ACM Tri-Ada Conference}, |
---|
656 | organization= {ACM}, |
---|
657 | address = {San Jose, California, U.S.A}, |
---|
658 | month = oct, |
---|
659 | year = 1991, |
---|
660 | pages = {338-346}, |
---|
661 | } |
---|
662 | |
---|
663 | @article{Havender68, |
---|
664 | keywords = {deadlock}, |
---|
665 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
666 | author = {J. W. Havender}, |
---|
667 | title = {Avoiding Deadlock in Multitasking Systems}, |
---|
668 | journal = ibmsj, |
---|
669 | volume = 7, |
---|
670 | number = 2, |
---|
671 | year = 1968, |
---|
672 | pages = {74-84}, |
---|
673 | } |
---|
674 | |
---|
675 | % B |
---|
676 | |
---|
677 | @incollection{beta:old, |
---|
678 | keywords = {beta, patterns, virtual types}, |
---|
679 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
680 | author = {Bent Bruun Kristensen and Ole Lehrmann Madsen and Birger M{\o}ller-Pedersen and Kristen Nygaard}, |
---|
681 | title = {The BETA Programming Language}, |
---|
682 | booktitle = {Research Directions in Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
683 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
684 | series = {Computer Systems Series}, |
---|
685 | year = 1987, |
---|
686 | pages = {7-48}, |
---|
687 | editor = {Bruce Shriver and Peter Wegner} |
---|
688 | } |
---|
689 | |
---|
690 | @article{Knudsen87, |
---|
691 | keyword = {static exception handling mechanism, BETA, sequel}, |
---|
692 | contributor = {wyrmok@plg}, |
---|
693 | author = {J{\o}rgen Lindskov Knudsen}, |
---|
694 | title = {Better Exception Handling in Block Structured Systems}, |
---|
695 | journal = {IEEE Software}, |
---|
696 | year = 1987, |
---|
697 | month = may, |
---|
698 | volume = 4, |
---|
699 | number = 3, |
---|
700 | pages = {40-49}, |
---|
701 | comments = { |
---|
702 | Going up the call hierarchy to look for a handler does not fit an |
---|
703 | otherwise statically scoped language. Also, not knowing which handler |
---|
704 | to be used when raising an abnormal event is seen as a weakness of the |
---|
705 | (dynamic) exception handling mechanism. Knudsen believed that raising |
---|
706 | an exception should specify the handler for the exception -- the |
---|
707 | handler is chosen when the exception is raised. However, I don't think |
---|
708 | his scheme can solve the problem, especially with all the callback |
---|
709 | routines commonly found in OO programming. |
---|
710 | |
---|
711 | BETA exception handling mechanism uses his work as a foundation. |
---|
712 | However, I don't see any benefits BETA has over other language that is |
---|
713 | a direct consequence of Knudsen's work. On the other hand, my knowledge |
---|
714 | on BETA is very limited. |
---|
715 | } |
---|
716 | } |
---|
717 | |
---|
718 | @book{BCPL, |
---|
719 | keywords = {BCPL}, |
---|
720 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
721 | author = {M. Richards and C. Whitby-Strevens}, |
---|
722 | title = {{BCPL} -- The Language and Its Compiler}, |
---|
723 | publisher = {Cambridge University Press, Cambridge}, |
---|
724 | year = 1979, |
---|
725 | } |
---|
726 | |
---|
727 | @incollection{Madsen87, |
---|
728 | keywords = {nested classes}, |
---|
729 | contributer = {pabuhr@watmsg}, |
---|
730 | author = {Ole Lehrmann Madsen}, |
---|
731 | title = {Block Structure and Object Oriented Languages}, |
---|
732 | booktitle = {Research Directions in Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
733 | editor = {Bruce Shriver and Peter Wegner}, |
---|
734 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
735 | series = {Computer Systems Series}, |
---|
736 | year = 1987, |
---|
737 | pages = {113-128} |
---|
738 | } |
---|
739 | |
---|
740 | @inproceedings{booleanClasses, |
---|
741 | keywords = {specifications}, |
---|
742 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
743 | author = {David McAllester and Ramin Zabih}, |
---|
744 | title = {Boolean Classes}, |
---|
745 | crossref = "OOPSLA86", |
---|
746 | pages = {417-423}, |
---|
747 | abstract = { |
---|
748 | We extend the notion of class so that any Boolean combination of |
---|
749 | classes is also a class. Boolean classes allow greater precision |
---|
750 | and conciseness in naming the class of objects governed a |
---|
751 | particular method [sic]. A class can be viewed as a predicate |
---|
752 | which is either true or false of any given object. Unlike |
---|
753 | predicates however classes have an inheritance hierarchy which is |
---|
754 | known at compile time. Boolean classes extend the notion of class, |
---|
755 | making classes more like predicates, while preserving the compile |
---|
756 | time computable inheritance hierarchy. |
---|
757 | }, |
---|
758 | comment = { |
---|
759 | Classes are predicates; if object {\tt o} is in class {\tt C}, then |
---|
760 | {\tt C} is true of {\tt o}. Classes are combined with {\tt :AND}, |
---|
761 | {\tt :OR}, and {\tt :NOT}. Inheritance is treated as implication: |
---|
762 | {\tt (:implies C E)} means that if class {\tt C} is true of {\tt |
---|
763 | o}, class expression {\tt E} is true of {\tt o}, so if {\tt E} is a |
---|
764 | class, it is a superclass of {\tt C}. Some class expressions, i.e. |
---|
765 | {\tt (:OR c1 c2)}, can't be instantiated. Others, i.e. {\tt (:NOT |
---|
766 | c)}, can't be given methods or members because almost all classes |
---|
767 | would inherit them, violating modularity. The rules for spotting |
---|
768 | these problems are complex. Determining if one class inherits from |
---|
769 | another needs an exponential algorithm. |
---|
770 | } |
---|
771 | } |
---|
772 | |
---|
773 | @misc{BoostCoroutines15, |
---|
774 | keywords = {Boost Coroutine Library}, |
---|
775 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
776 | author = {Oliver Kowalke}, |
---|
777 | title = {Boost Coroutine Library}, |
---|
778 | year = 2015, |
---|
779 | note = {\href{http://www.boost.org/doc/libs/1_61_0/libs/coroutine/doc/html/index.html} |
---|
780 | {{http://www.boost.org/\-doc/\-libs/1\_61\_0/\-libs/\-coroutine/\-doc/\-html/\-index.html}} [Accessed September 2016]}, |
---|
781 | } |
---|
782 | |
---|
783 | @mastersthesis{Krischer02, |
---|
784 | author = {Roy Krischer }, |
---|
785 | title = {Bound Exceptions in Object-Oriented Programming Languages}, |
---|
786 | school = {Universit\"at Mannheim}, |
---|
787 | address = {Mannheim, Deutschland}, |
---|
788 | year = 2002, |
---|
789 | month = oct, |
---|
790 | type = {Diplomarbeit}, |
---|
791 | note = {{\small\textsf{ftp://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-pub/\-theses/\-KrischerThesis.ps.gz}}}, |
---|
792 | } |
---|
793 | |
---|
794 | @inproceedings{Buhr03, |
---|
795 | keywords = {exception handling, bound handler}, |
---|
796 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
797 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Roy Krischer}, |
---|
798 | title = {Bound Exceptions in Object Programming}, |
---|
799 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the ECOOP 2003 Workshop on Exception Handling in Object Oriented Systems: |
---|
800 | Towards Emerging Application Areas and New Programming Paradigms}, |
---|
801 | organization= {ECOOP}, |
---|
802 | address = {Darmstadt, Germany}, |
---|
803 | month = jul, |
---|
804 | year = 2003, |
---|
805 | pages = {20-26}, |
---|
806 | } |
---|
807 | % note = {http://www.cs.umn.edu/research/technical_reports.php/listing/technical_reports.php?page=report&report_id=03-028} |
---|
808 | |
---|
809 | @inproceedings{Buhr06b, |
---|
810 | keywords = {exception handling, bound exceptions}, |
---|
811 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Roy Krischer}, |
---|
812 | title = {Bound Exceptions in Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
813 | editor = {C. Dony and J. L. Knudsen and A. Romanovsky and A. Tripathi}, |
---|
814 | booktitle = {Advanced Topics in Exception Handling Techniques}, |
---|
815 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
816 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science}, |
---|
817 | volume = 4119, |
---|
818 | year = 2006, |
---|
819 | pages = {1-21} |
---|
820 | } |
---|
821 | |
---|
822 | % C |
---|
823 | |
---|
824 | @book{C, |
---|
825 | keywords = {C}, |
---|
826 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
827 | author = {Brian W. Kernighan and Dennis M. Ritchie}, |
---|
828 | title = {The {C} Programming Language}, |
---|
829 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
830 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
831 | year = 1988, |
---|
832 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
833 | series = {Prentice-Hall Software Series}, |
---|
834 | comment = { |
---|
835 | based on draft-proposed ANSI C |
---|
836 | } |
---|
837 | } |
---|
838 | |
---|
839 | @book{C:old, |
---|
840 | keywords = {C}, |
---|
841 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
842 | author = {Brian W. Kernighan and Dennis M. Ritchie}, |
---|
843 | title = {The {C} Programming Language}, |
---|
844 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
845 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
846 | year = 1978, |
---|
847 | edition = {1st}, |
---|
848 | } |
---|
849 | |
---|
850 | @manual{ANSI89:C, |
---|
851 | keywords = {ANSI C 89}, |
---|
852 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
853 | title = {American National Standard for Information Systems -- Programming Language -- {C}}, |
---|
854 | organization= {American National Standards Institute}, |
---|
855 | address = {1430 Broadway, New York, New York 10018}, |
---|
856 | month = dec, |
---|
857 | year = 1989, |
---|
858 | note = {X3.159-1989} |
---|
859 | } |
---|
860 | |
---|
861 | @manual{C11, |
---|
862 | keywords = {ISO/IEC C 11}, |
---|
863 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
864 | key = {C11}, |
---|
865 | title = {American National Standard Information technology -- Programming Languages -- {C}}, |
---|
866 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 9899-2011[2012]}, |
---|
867 | publisher = {International Standard Organization}, |
---|
868 | address = {http://www.iso.org}, |
---|
869 | year = 2012, |
---|
870 | } |
---|
871 | |
---|
872 | @manual{C++Concepts, |
---|
873 | keywords = {ISO/IEC TS 19217:2015}, |
---|
874 | contributer = {a3moss@uwaterloo.ca}, |
---|
875 | key = {C++ Concepts}, |
---|
876 | title = {Information technology -- Programming languages -- {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Extensions for concepts}, |
---|
877 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC TS 19217:2015}, |
---|
878 | publisher = {International Standard Organization}, |
---|
879 | address = {http://www.iso.org}, |
---|
880 | year = 2015 |
---|
881 | } |
---|
882 | |
---|
883 | @mastersthesis{Esteves04, |
---|
884 | keywords = {Cforall, parametric polymorphism, overloading}, |
---|
885 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
886 | author = {Rodolfo Gabriel Esteves}, |
---|
887 | title = {C$\forall$, a Study in Evolutionary Design in Programming Languages}, |
---|
888 | school = {School of Computer Science, University of Waterloo}, |
---|
889 | year = 2004, |
---|
890 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
891 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/theses/EstevesThesis.pdf}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-theses/\-EstevesThesis.pdf}}, |
---|
892 | } |
---|
893 | |
---|
894 | @inproceedings{c++scheme, |
---|
895 | keywords = {}, |
---|
896 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
897 | author = {Vincent F. Russo and Simon M. Kaplan}, |
---|
898 | title = {A {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Interpreter for {S}cheme}, |
---|
899 | booktitle = {Usenix {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Conference}, |
---|
900 | year = 1988, |
---|
901 | pages = {95-108}, |
---|
902 | summary = { |
---|
903 | The SIOD interpreter for a Scheme subset, written in C, has a |
---|
904 | tagged union representing data objects, and read(), eval(), and |
---|
905 | print() functions that are basically large switch statements that |
---|
906 | switch based on the tag. The authors rewrote it to use a class |
---|
907 | with virtual read(), eval(), and print() members, without changing |
---|
908 | any algorithms. The result was more modular, more easily |
---|
909 | extensible, more reliable, and slightly faster. |
---|
910 | }, |
---|
911 | comment = { |
---|
912 | The evidence given is thin. |
---|
913 | } |
---|
914 | } |
---|
915 | |
---|
916 | @article{doskernel, |
---|
917 | keywords = {light weight processes}, |
---|
918 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
919 | author = {Tom Green}, |
---|
920 | title = {A {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Multitasking Kernel}, |
---|
921 | journal = {Dr. Dobb's Journal of Software Tools}, |
---|
922 | year = 1989, |
---|
923 | month = feb, volume = 14, number = 2, pages = {45-51}, |
---|
924 | comment = { |
---|
925 | A light-weight multitasking kernel for MS-DOS. A task\_control |
---|
926 | object holds task objects, which may block themselves on signal |
---|
927 | objects. Task switching is normally preemptive, but tasks can turn |
---|
928 | off preemption before calling non-reentrant routines. Source code |
---|
929 | is given. |
---|
930 | } |
---|
931 | } |
---|
932 | |
---|
933 | @inproceedings{Doeppner87, |
---|
934 | keywords = {concurrency}, |
---|
935 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
936 | author = {Thomas W. Doeppner and Alan J. Gebele}, |
---|
937 | title = {{C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} on a Parallel Machine}, |
---|
938 | booktitle = {Proceedings and Additional Papers {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Workshop}, |
---|
939 | organization= {USENIX Association}, |
---|
940 | address = {Santa Fe, New Mexico, U.S.A}, |
---|
941 | month = nov, |
---|
942 | year = 1987, |
---|
943 | pages = {94-107}, |
---|
944 | } |
---|
945 | |
---|
946 | @book{Lippman91, |
---|
947 | keywords = {C++}, |
---|
948 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
949 | author = {Stanley B. Lippman}, |
---|
950 | title = {{C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Primer}, |
---|
951 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
952 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
953 | year = 1991, |
---|
954 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
955 | note = {QA76.73.C15L57}, |
---|
956 | } |
---|
957 | |
---|
958 | @book{c++:v1, |
---|
959 | keywords = {C++}, |
---|
960 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
961 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
962 | title = {The {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Programming Language}, |
---|
963 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
964 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
965 | year = 1986, |
---|
966 | edition = {1st}, |
---|
967 | series = {Addison-Wesley Series in Computer Science} |
---|
968 | } |
---|
969 | |
---|
970 | @book{c++:v2, |
---|
971 | keywords = {C++}, |
---|
972 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
973 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
974 | title = {The {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Programming Language}, |
---|
975 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
976 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
977 | year = 1991, |
---|
978 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
979 | } |
---|
980 | |
---|
981 | @book{c++:v3, |
---|
982 | keywords = {C++}, |
---|
983 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
984 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
985 | title = {The {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Programming Language}, |
---|
986 | publisher = {Addison Wesley Longman}, |
---|
987 | year = 1997, |
---|
988 | edition = {3rd}, |
---|
989 | } |
---|
990 | |
---|
991 | @manual{Csharp, |
---|
992 | keywords = {C#}, |
---|
993 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
994 | title = {C\# Language Specification, Standard ECMA-334}, |
---|
995 | organization= {ECMA International Standardizing Information and Communication Systems}, |
---|
996 | month = jun, |
---|
997 | year = 2006, |
---|
998 | edition = {4th}, |
---|
999 | } |
---|
1000 | |
---|
1001 | @article{Buhr85, |
---|
1002 | keywords = {goto, multi-exit loop}, |
---|
1003 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1004 | author = {P. A. Buhr}, |
---|
1005 | title = {A Case for Teaching Multi-exit Loops to Beginning Programmers}, |
---|
1006 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
1007 | volume = 20, |
---|
1008 | number = 11, |
---|
1009 | month = nov, |
---|
1010 | year = 1985, |
---|
1011 | pages = {14-22} |
---|
1012 | } |
---|
1013 | |
---|
1014 | @techreport{cforall-ug, |
---|
1015 | keywords = {cforall, user guide}, |
---|
1016 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1017 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Glen Ditchfield and David Till and Charles R. Zarnke}, |
---|
1018 | title = {\mbox{\mdseries\sffamily C{$\mathbf{\forall}$}}\ Users Guide, Version 0.1}, |
---|
1019 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo}, |
---|
1020 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
1021 | month = oct, |
---|
1022 | year = 2001, |
---|
1023 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/~cforall/cfa.ps}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-\char`\~cforall/\-cfa.ps}}, |
---|
1024 | } |
---|
1025 | |
---|
1026 | @manual{cforall, |
---|
1027 | keywords = {polymorphism}, |
---|
1028 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1029 | author = {Glen Ditchfield}, |
---|
1030 | title = {Cforall Reference Manual and Rationale}, |
---|
1031 | edition = {Revision 1.82}, |
---|
1032 | month = jan, |
---|
1033 | year = 1998, |
---|
1034 | note = {{\small\textsf{ftp://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-pub/\-Cforall/\-refrat.ps.gz}}}, |
---|
1035 | } |
---|
1036 | |
---|
1037 | @book{Yourdon79, |
---|
1038 | keywords = {software engineering}, |
---|
1039 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1040 | editor = {Edward Nash Yourdon}, |
---|
1041 | title = {Classics in Software Engineering}, |
---|
1042 | publisher = {Yourdon Press}, |
---|
1043 | address = {New York}, |
---|
1044 | year = 1979, |
---|
1045 | } |
---|
1046 | |
---|
1047 | @inproceedings{Crnogorac98, |
---|
1048 | keywords = {inheritance anomaly}, |
---|
1049 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1050 | author = {Lobel Crnogorac and Anand S. Rao and Kotagiri Ramamohanarao}, |
---|
1051 | title = {Classifying Inheritance Mechanisms in Concurrent Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
1052 | editor = {Eric Jul}, |
---|
1053 | booktitle = {{ECOOP}~'98---Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
1054 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science}, |
---|
1055 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
1056 | volume = 1445, |
---|
1057 | year = 1998, |
---|
1058 | pages = {571-601}, |
---|
1059 | ISBN = {3-540-64737-6}, |
---|
1060 | ISSN = {0302-9743}, |
---|
1061 | abstract = { |
---|
1062 | Inheritance is one of the key concepts in object-oriented rogramming. However, the |
---|
1063 | usefulness of inheritance in concurrent object-oriented programming is greatly |
---|
1064 | reduced by the problem of inheritance anomaly. Inheritance anomaly is manifested |
---|
1065 | by undesirable re-definitions of inherited code. The problem is aggravated by the |
---|
1066 | lack of a formal analysis, with a multitude of differing proposals and conflicting |
---|
1067 | opinions causing the current state of research, and further directions, to be |
---|
1068 | unclear. In this paper we present a formal analysis of inheritance anomaly in |
---|
1069 | concurrent object-oriented programming. Starting from a formal definition of the |
---|
1070 | problem we develop a taxonomy of the anomaly, and use it to classify the various |
---|
1071 | proposals. As a result, the major ideas, trends and limitations of the various |
---|
1072 | proposals are clearly exposed. Formal analysis of the anomaly and a thorough |
---|
1073 | exposition of its causes and implications are the pre-requisites for a successful |
---|
1074 | integration of inheritance and concurrency. |
---|
1075 | }, |
---|
1076 | } |
---|
1077 | |
---|
1078 | @book{CLU, |
---|
1079 | keywords = {CLU}, |
---|
1080 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1081 | author = {Barbara Liskov and Russell Atkinson and Toby Bloom and Eliot |
---|
1082 | Moss and J. Craig Schaffert and Robert Scheifler and Alan Snyder}, |
---|
1083 | title = {CLU Reference Manual}, |
---|
1084 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
1085 | address = {New York}, |
---|
1086 | year = 1981, |
---|
1087 | volume = 114, |
---|
1088 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science} |
---|
1089 | } |
---|
1090 | |
---|
1091 | @manual{Cobol14, |
---|
1092 | keywords = {ISO/IEC Cobol 14}, |
---|
1093 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1094 | key = {Cobol14}, |
---|
1095 | title = {Programming Languages -- {Cobol}}, |
---|
1096 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
1097 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 1989:2014}, |
---|
1098 | publisher = {International Standard Organization}, |
---|
1099 | address = {http://www.iso.org}, |
---|
1100 | year = 2014, |
---|
1101 | } |
---|
1102 | |
---|
1103 | @article{coagulation, |
---|
1104 | keywords = {register allocation, instruction selection, jello}, |
---|
1105 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1106 | author = {Michael Karr}, |
---|
1107 | title = {Code Generation by Coagulation}, |
---|
1108 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
1109 | year = 1984, |
---|
1110 | month = jun, volume = 19, number = 6, pages = {1-12}, |
---|
1111 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN '84 Symposium on Compiler Construction}, |
---|
1112 | abstract = { |
---|
1113 | This paper describes a new approach to code-generation. The |
---|
1114 | central tenet is that there must be a more intimate coupling |
---|
1115 | between register allocation and instruction selection than exists |
---|
1116 | in present-day technology. This is achieved by generating code in |
---|
1117 | very small regions and gradually coalescing the part of the program |
---|
1118 | that is ``compiled''. |
---|
1119 | }, |
---|
1120 | comment = { |
---|
1121 | Imagine the program, including the subroutines, spread out over a |
---|
1122 | table, with the compiler dropping Jello on the parts as they are |
---|
1123 | compiled. At first little drops appear in seemingly random places. |
---|
1124 | These get bigger and combine with other drops to form growing |
---|
1125 | globs. When two globs meet, ripples will go out through each as |
---|
1126 | they adjust to each other's presence, although the parts of the |
---|
1127 | globs that formed first are less affected by the ripples. When |
---|
1128 | compilation is complete, there is one congealed mass. |
---|
1129 | } |
---|
1130 | } |
---|
1131 | |
---|
1132 | @article{Soloway83, |
---|
1133 | keywords = {goto, structure programming}, |
---|
1134 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1135 | author = {E. Soloway and J. Bonar and K. Ehrlich}, |
---|
1136 | title = {Cognitive Strategies and Looping Constructs: An Empirical Study}, |
---|
1137 | journal = cacm, |
---|
1138 | month = nov, |
---|
1139 | year = 1983, |
---|
1140 | volume = 26, |
---|
1141 | number = 11, |
---|
1142 | pages = {853-860}, |
---|
1143 | } |
---|
1144 | |
---|
1145 | @book{sml:commentary, |
---|
1146 | author = {Robin Milner and Mads Tofte}, |
---|
1147 | title = {Commentary on Standard {ML}}, |
---|
1148 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
1149 | address = {Cambridge}, |
---|
1150 | year = 1991 |
---|
1151 | } |
---|
1152 | |
---|
1153 | @article{Hyman66, |
---|
1154 | keywords = {mutual exclusion, software solution, incorrect}, |
---|
1155 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1156 | author = {Harris Hyman}, |
---|
1157 | title = {Comments on a Problem in Concurrent Programming Control}, |
---|
1158 | journal = cacm, |
---|
1159 | month = jan, |
---|
1160 | year = 1966, |
---|
1161 | volume = 9, |
---|
1162 | number = 1, |
---|
1163 | pages = {45}, |
---|
1164 | note = {Letter to the Editor} |
---|
1165 | } |
---|
1166 | |
---|
1167 | @inproceedings{clos, |
---|
1168 | keywords = {}, |
---|
1169 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1170 | author = {Linda G. DeMichiel and Richard P. Gabriel}, |
---|
1171 | title = {The Common Lisp Object System: An Overview}, |
---|
1172 | booktitle = {ECOOP '87. European Conference on Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
1173 | year = 1987, |
---|
1174 | pages = {151-170}, |
---|
1175 | publisher = {Springer} |
---|
1176 | } |
---|
1177 | |
---|
1178 | @book{CommonLisp, |
---|
1179 | keywords = {common lisp}, |
---|
1180 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1181 | author = {Guy Steele}, |
---|
1182 | title = {COMMON LISP: The Language}, |
---|
1183 | publisher = {Digital Press}, |
---|
1184 | address = {New York}, |
---|
1185 | year = 1984 |
---|
1186 | } |
---|
1187 | |
---|
1188 | @article{CommonLoops, |
---|
1189 | author = {D. Bobrow and K. Kahn and G. Kiczales and L. Masinter and M. Stefik and F. Zdybel}, |
---|
1190 | title = {CommonLoops: Merging Common Lisp and Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
1191 | address = {Portland, Oregon, U.S.A.}, |
---|
1192 | journal = {Proc. ACM Conf. on Object-Oriented Systems, Languages and Applications}, |
---|
1193 | year = 1986, |
---|
1194 | month = sep, |
---|
1195 | pages = {17-29}, |
---|
1196 | } |
---|
1197 | |
---|
1198 | @article{co-overview, |
---|
1199 | keywords = {CommonObjects, implementation, encapsulation}, |
---|
1200 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1201 | author = {Alan Snyder}, |
---|
1202 | title = {CommonObjects: An Overview}, |
---|
1203 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
1204 | year = 1986, |
---|
1205 | month = oct, volume = 21, number = 10, pages = {19-28}, |
---|
1206 | note = {Object Oriented Programming Workshop} |
---|
1207 | } |
---|
1208 | |
---|
1209 | @article{CSP, |
---|
1210 | keywords = {CSP, concurrency}, |
---|
1211 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1212 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare}, |
---|
1213 | title = {Communicating Sequential Processes}, |
---|
1214 | journal = cacm, |
---|
1215 | month = aug, |
---|
1216 | year = 1978, |
---|
1217 | volume = 21, |
---|
1218 | number = 8, |
---|
1219 | pages = {666-677} |
---|
1220 | } |
---|
1221 | |
---|
1222 | @book{Hoare85, |
---|
1223 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare}, |
---|
1224 | title = {Communicating Sequential Processes}, |
---|
1225 | year = 1985, |
---|
1226 | isbn = {0-13-153271-5}, |
---|
1227 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
1228 | address = {Upper Saddle River, NJ, USA}, |
---|
1229 | note = {\href{http://www.usingcsp.com/cspbook.pdf}{http://\-www.usingcsp.com/\-cspbook.pdf}}, |
---|
1230 | } |
---|
1231 | |
---|
1232 | @article{Hansen72a, |
---|
1233 | keywords = {monitors, automatic signal}, |
---|
1234 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1235 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}}, |
---|
1236 | title = {A Comparison of Two Synchronizing Concepts}, |
---|
1237 | journal = acta, |
---|
1238 | volume = 1, |
---|
1239 | year = 1972, |
---|
1240 | pages = {190-199}, |
---|
1241 | } |
---|
1242 | |
---|
1243 | @book{Aho06, |
---|
1244 | author = {Alfred V. Aho and Monica S. Lam and Ravi Sethi and Jeffrey D. Ullman}, |
---|
1245 | title = {Compilers: Principles, Techniques, and Tools}, |
---|
1246 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
1247 | year = {2006}, |
---|
1248 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley Longman Publishing}, |
---|
1249 | address = {Boston, MA, USA}, |
---|
1250 | } |
---|
1251 | |
---|
1252 | @article{Bacon94, |
---|
1253 | keywords = {parallelizing compiler}, |
---|
1254 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1255 | author = {David F. Bacon and Susan L. Graham and Oliver J. Sharp}, |
---|
1256 | title = {Compiler Transformations for High-Performance Com\-puting}, |
---|
1257 | journal = acmcs, |
---|
1258 | volume = 26, |
---|
1259 | number = 4, |
---|
1260 | month = dec, |
---|
1261 | year = 1994, |
---|
1262 | pages = {345-420}, |
---|
1263 | } |
---|
1264 | |
---|
1265 | @inproceedings{Berger01, |
---|
1266 | author = {Emery D. Berger and Benjamin G. Zorn and Kathryn S. McKinley}, |
---|
1267 | title = {Composing High-Performance Memory Allocators}, |
---|
1268 | booktitle = {{SIGPLAN} Conference on Programming Language Design and Implementation}, |
---|
1269 | pages = {114-124}, |
---|
1270 | year = 2001, |
---|
1271 | url = {http://citeseer.ist.psu.edu/berger01composing.html} |
---|
1272 | } |
---|
1273 | |
---|
1274 | @article{Andrews83, |
---|
1275 | keywords = {general concurrency}, |
---|
1276 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1277 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews and Fred B. Schneider}, |
---|
1278 | title = {Concepts and Notations for Concurrent Programming}, |
---|
1279 | journal = acmcs, |
---|
1280 | volume = 15, |
---|
1281 | number = 1, |
---|
1282 | month = mar, |
---|
1283 | year = 1983, |
---|
1284 | pages = {3-43}, |
---|
1285 | } |
---|
1286 | |
---|
1287 | @mastersthesis{Mok97, |
---|
1288 | author = {Wing Yeung Russell Mok}, |
---|
1289 | title = {Concurrent Abnormal Event Handling Mechanisms}, |
---|
1290 | school = {University of Waterloo}, |
---|
1291 | year = 1997, |
---|
1292 | month = sep, |
---|
1293 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
1294 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/theses/MokThesis.pdf}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-theses/\-MokThesis.pdf}}, |
---|
1295 | } |
---|
1296 | |
---|
1297 | @article{Gehani86, |
---|
1298 | keywords = {Concurrent programming, C, Distributed systems, rendezvous}, |
---|
1299 | contributer = {dgharriss@plg}, |
---|
1300 | author = {N. H. Gehani and W. D. Roome}, |
---|
1301 | title = {{Concurrent C}}, |
---|
1302 | journal = spe, |
---|
1303 | volume = 16, |
---|
1304 | number = 9, |
---|
1305 | month = sep, |
---|
1306 | year = 1986, |
---|
1307 | pages = {821-844}, |
---|
1308 | abstract = { |
---|
1309 | Our objective is to enhance C so that it can be used to write |
---|
1310 | concurrent programs that can run efficiently on both single computers |
---|
1311 | and multicomputers. Our concurrent programming extensions to C are |
---|
1312 | based on the {\it rendezvous\/} concept. These extensions include |
---|
1313 | mechanisms for the declaration and creation of processes, for process |
---|
1314 | synchronization and interaction, for process termination and abortion. |
---|
1315 | We give a rationale for our decisions and compare Concurrent C |
---|
1316 | extensions with the concurrent programming facilities in Ada. |
---|
1317 | Concurrent C has been implemented on the UNIX system running on a |
---|
1318 | single processor. A distributed version of Concurrent C is being |
---|
1319 | implemented. |
---|
1320 | }, |
---|
1321 | comment = { |
---|
1322 | Select with guarded and screened accepts. Typed processes. |
---|
1323 | Process-valued expressions and process variables. Processes have |
---|
1324 | execution priority: Create {\em process-type-name}(args) [with |
---|
1325 | priority(p)], |
---|
1326 | and the priority can be changed on the fly. Complicated guard/ |
---|
1327 | screen structure on accept: accept {\em transaction}(param names) |
---|
1328 | [suchthat (exp)] [by (exp)] [compoundstatement]. Accepts cannot |
---|
1329 | appear in functions! Can specify timeouts on transaction calls. |
---|
1330 | Code examples: buffer process, dining philosophers, lock manager. |
---|
1331 | Section on diffs between Concurrent C and Ada. |
---|
1332 | } |
---|
1333 | } |
---|
1334 | |
---|
1335 | @article{ConcurrentC++, |
---|
1336 | keywords = {concurrency, C++}, |
---|
1337 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1338 | author = {N. H. Gehani and W. D. Roome}, |
---|
1339 | title = {Concurrent {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}: Concurrent Programming with Class(es)}, |
---|
1340 | journal = spe, |
---|
1341 | month = dec, |
---|
1342 | year = 1988, |
---|
1343 | volume = 18, |
---|
1344 | number = 12, |
---|
1345 | pages = {1157-1177} |
---|
1346 | } |
---|
1347 | |
---|
1348 | @article{Courtois71, |
---|
1349 | keywords = {reader and writer, p and v}, |
---|
1350 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1351 | author = {P. J. Courtois and F. Heymans and D. L. Parnas}, |
---|
1352 | title = {Concurrent Control with Readers and Writers}, |
---|
1353 | journal = cacm, |
---|
1354 | volume = 14, |
---|
1355 | number = 10, |
---|
1356 | month = oct, |
---|
1357 | year = 1971, |
---|
1358 | pages = {667-668}, |
---|
1359 | annote = { |
---|
1360 | Many errors in the two solutions. |
---|
1361 | } |
---|
1362 | } |
---|
1363 | |
---|
1364 | @incollection{Reppy93, |
---|
1365 | keywords = {ML, concurrency, continuation passing}, |
---|
1366 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1367 | author = {John H. Reppy}, |
---|
1368 | title = {Concurrent {ML}: Design, Application and Semantics}, |
---|
1369 | booktitle = {Functional Programming, Concurrency, Simulation and Automated Reasoning}, |
---|
1370 | editor = {P. E. Lauer}, |
---|
1371 | pages = {165-198}, |
---|
1372 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
1373 | address = {Berlin, DE}, |
---|
1374 | year = 1993, |
---|
1375 | ISBN = {3-540-56883-2}, |
---|
1376 | abstract = { |
---|
1377 | Concurrent ML (CML) is a high-level language for concurrent |
---|
1378 | programming. It is an extension of Standard ML (SML) and is implemented |
---|
1379 | on top of Standard ML of New Jersey (SML/NJ). CML is a practical |
---|
1380 | language and is being used to build real systems. It demonstrates that |
---|
1381 | one need not sacrifice high-level notation in order to have good |
---|
1382 | performance. CML is also a well-defined language. In the tradition of |
---|
1383 | SML, it has a formal semantics and its type-soundness has been |
---|
1384 | proven.}, |
---|
1385 | note = { |
---|
1386 | Proceedings of International Lecture Series 1991-92, McMaster |
---|
1387 | UniversityLecture Notes in Computer Science 693.}, |
---|
1388 | } |
---|
1389 | |
---|
1390 | @article{BLASE-2, |
---|
1391 | keywords = {concurrency, BLASE-2}, |
---|
1392 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1393 | author = {Piyush Mehrotra and John Van Rosendale}, |
---|
1394 | title = {Concurrent Object Access in BLASE~2}, |
---|
1395 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
1396 | volume = 24, |
---|
1397 | number = 4, |
---|
1398 | month = apr, |
---|
1399 | year = 1989, |
---|
1400 | pages = {40-42}, |
---|
1401 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN Workshop on Object-Based Concurrent Programming, |
---|
1402 | Sept. 26--27, 1988, San Diego, California, U.S.A}, |
---|
1403 | } |
---|
1404 | |
---|
1405 | @techreport{Kafura88, |
---|
1406 | keywords = {objects, concurrency}, |
---|
1407 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1408 | author = {Dennis Kafura}, |
---|
1409 | title = {Concurrent Object-Oriented Real-Time Systems Research}, |
---|
1410 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, Virginia Polytechnic}, |
---|
1411 | number = {TR 88-47}, |
---|
1412 | year = 1988 |
---|
1413 | } |
---|
1414 | |
---|
1415 | @article{Buhr92a, |
---|
1416 | keywords = {C++, concurrency, light-weight process, shared memory}, |
---|
1417 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1418 | author = {P. A. Buhr and Glen Ditchfield and R. A. Stroobosscher and B. M. Younger and C. R. Zarnke}, |
---|
1419 | title = {$\mu${C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}: Concurrency in the Object-Oriented Language {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
1420 | journal = spe, |
---|
1421 | volume = 22, |
---|
1422 | number = 2, |
---|
1423 | month = feb, |
---|
1424 | year = 1992, |
---|
1425 | pages = {137-172}, |
---|
1426 | } |
---|
1427 | |
---|
1428 | @techreport{uC++, |
---|
1429 | keywords = {C++, concurrency, light-weight process, shared memory}, |
---|
1430 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1431 | author = {Peter A. Buhr}, |
---|
1432 | title = {$\mu${C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Annotated Reference Manual, Version 6.1.0}, |
---|
1433 | institution = {School of Computer Science, University of Waterloo}, |
---|
1434 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
1435 | month = jul, |
---|
1436 | year = 2015, |
---|
1437 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/~usystem/pub/uSystem/u++-6.1.0.sh}{\textsf{http://\-plg.\-uwaterloo.\-ca/\-$\sim$usystem/\-pub/\-uSystem/\-u++-6.1.0.sh}}}, |
---|
1438 | } |
---|
1439 | |
---|
1440 | @book{Burns93, |
---|
1441 | keywords = {concurrency, Pascal}, |
---|
1442 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1443 | author = {Alan Burns and Geoff Davies}, |
---|
1444 | title = {Concurrent Programming}, |
---|
1445 | publisher = {Addison Wesley Longman}, |
---|
1446 | year = 1993, |
---|
1447 | } |
---|
1448 | |
---|
1449 | @article{Hansen73a, |
---|
1450 | keywords = {monitors}, |
---|
1451 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1452 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}}, |
---|
1453 | title = {Concurrent Programming Concepts}, |
---|
1454 | journal = spe, |
---|
1455 | month = dec, |
---|
1456 | year = 1973, |
---|
1457 | volume = 5, |
---|
1458 | number = 4, |
---|
1459 | pages = {223-245}, |
---|
1460 | } |
---|
1461 | |
---|
1462 | @book{Lea97, |
---|
1463 | keywords = {concurrency, Java}, |
---|
1464 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1465 | author = {Doug Lea}, |
---|
1466 | title = {Concurrent Programming in {J}ava: Design Principles and Patterns}, |
---|
1467 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
1468 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
1469 | year = 1997, |
---|
1470 | edition = {1st}, |
---|
1471 | } |
---|
1472 | |
---|
1473 | @book{Hartley98, |
---|
1474 | keywords = {concurrency, Java}, |
---|
1475 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1476 | author = {Stephen J. Hartley}, |
---|
1477 | title = {Concurrent Programming: The {J}ava Programming Language}, |
---|
1478 | publisher = {Oxford University Press}, |
---|
1479 | year = 1998, |
---|
1480 | edition = {1st}, |
---|
1481 | } |
---|
1482 | |
---|
1483 | @book{Lea00, |
---|
1484 | keywords = {concurrency, Java}, |
---|
1485 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1486 | author = {Doug Lea}, |
---|
1487 | title = {Concurrent Programming in {J}ava: Design Principles and Patterns}, |
---|
1488 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
1489 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
1490 | year = 2000, |
---|
1491 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
1492 | } |
---|
1493 | |
---|
1494 | @book{ConcurrentC, |
---|
1495 | keywords = {concurrency, C}, |
---|
1496 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1497 | author = {N. H. Gehani and W. D. Roome}, |
---|
1498 | title = {The {Concurrent C} Programming Language}, |
---|
1499 | publisher = {Silicon Press}, |
---|
1500 | address = {Summit}, |
---|
1501 | year = 1989, |
---|
1502 | } |
---|
1503 | |
---|
1504 | @book{Andrews91:book, |
---|
1505 | keywords = {concurrency}, |
---|
1506 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1507 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews}, |
---|
1508 | title = {Concurrent Programming: Principles and Practice}, |
---|
1509 | publisher = {Benjamin/Cummings Publish\-ing}, |
---|
1510 | address = {Redwood City}, |
---|
1511 | year = 1991, |
---|
1512 | } |
---|
1513 | |
---|
1514 | @article{Buhr05a, |
---|
1515 | keywords = {concurrency, myths}, |
---|
1516 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1517 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Ashif S. Harji}, |
---|
1518 | title = {Concurrent Urban Legends}, |
---|
1519 | journal = ccpe, |
---|
1520 | month = aug, |
---|
1521 | year = 2005, |
---|
1522 | volume = 17, |
---|
1523 | number = 9, |
---|
1524 | pages = {1133-1172}, |
---|
1525 | } |
---|
1526 | |
---|
1527 | @techreport{Buhr90, |
---|
1528 | keywords = {objects, concurrency}, |
---|
1529 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1530 | author = {P. A. Buhr and G. J. Ditchfield and B. M. Younger and C. R. Zarnke}, |
---|
1531 | title = {Concurrency in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
1532 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo}, |
---|
1533 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
1534 | number = {CS-90-18}, |
---|
1535 | month = may, |
---|
1536 | year = 1990 |
---|
1537 | } |
---|
1538 | |
---|
1539 | @book{Burns98, |
---|
1540 | keywords = {concurrency, Ada}, |
---|
1541 | author = {Alan Burns and Andy Wellings}, |
---|
1542 | title = {Concurrency in {Ada}}, |
---|
1543 | publisher = {Cambridge University Press}, |
---|
1544 | year = 1998, |
---|
1545 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
1546 | } |
---|
1547 | |
---|
1548 | @book{Bernstein93, |
---|
1549 | keywords = {concurrency}, |
---|
1550 | author = {Arthur J. Bernstein and Philip M. Lewis}, |
---|
1551 | title = {Concurrency in Programming and Database Systems}, |
---|
1552 | publisher = {Jones and Bartlett}, |
---|
1553 | year = 1993, |
---|
1554 | } |
---|
1555 | |
---|
1556 | @inproceedings{Pitman01, |
---|
1557 | keywords = {LISP, exception handling}, |
---|
1558 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1559 | author = {Kent M. Pitman}, |
---|
1560 | title = {Condition Handling in the Lisp Language Family}, |
---|
1561 | booktitle = {Exception Handling}, |
---|
1562 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
1563 | volume = 2022, |
---|
1564 | series = {LNCS}, |
---|
1565 | year = 2001, |
---|
1566 | pages = {39-59} |
---|
1567 | } |
---|
1568 | |
---|
1569 | @inbook{enhancement, |
---|
1570 | keywords = {bounded polymorphism, Comandos}, |
---|
1571 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1572 | author = {Chris Horn}, |
---|
1573 | title = {Conformace, Genericity, Inheritance and Enhancement}, |
---|
1574 | pages = {223-233}, |
---|
1575 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
1576 | year = 1987, |
---|
1577 | volume = 276, |
---|
1578 | series = "Lecture Notes in Computer Science", |
---|
1579 | note = "ECOOP '87 European Conference on Object-Oriented Programming", |
---|
1580 | summary = { |
---|
1581 | Considers effect of conformance on Meyer's conclusions in |
---|
1582 | \cite{polymorphism}. |
---|
1583 | |
---|
1584 | Implementing a swap function as a member of a type {\cd Swappable} |
---|
1585 | with {\cd in out Top} parameters doesn't work, because conformance |
---|
1586 | requires arguments to be of type {\cd Top}. |
---|
1587 | |
---|
1588 | An enhancive type has a type parameter, bounded by some type, and |
---|
1589 | defines members. Types conforming to the bound can be passed as |
---|
1590 | arguments to create types with the extra members. The signature of |
---|
1591 | the enhanced type is based on the signature of the argument, not the |
---|
1592 | bound, as if enhancive types were macros. Hence enhanced types do not |
---|
1593 | necessarily conform to each other. Types conforming to the bound |
---|
1594 | conform to enhanced types, which allows new functions to be applied |
---|
1595 | to old types. |
---|
1596 | |
---|
1597 | Enhancive types are not generic types. If the argument is omitted, |
---|
1598 | the bound is used as a default. Assignment of enhanced types to |
---|
1599 | default-enhanced types is allowed (enhanced types conform to the |
---|
1600 | default-enhanced type). This is (probably) statically type-safe, |
---|
1601 | because arguments must conform to the bound, and the new members |
---|
1602 | only use operations defined for the bound. |
---|
1603 | |
---|
1604 | With facilities for member renaming and deletion, enhancive types |
---|
1605 | provide the equivalent of constrained generic types. |
---|
1606 | } |
---|
1607 | } |
---|
1608 | |
---|
1609 | @phdthesis{Ditchfield92, |
---|
1610 | keywords = {C, parametric polymorphism, overloading}, |
---|
1611 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1612 | author = {Glen Jeffrey Ditchfield}, |
---|
1613 | title = {Contextual Polymorphism}, |
---|
1614 | school = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo}, |
---|
1615 | year = 1992, |
---|
1616 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
1617 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/theses/DitchfieldThesis.pdf}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-theses/\-DitchfieldThesis.pdf}} |
---|
1618 | } |
---|
1619 | |
---|
1620 | @inproceedings{frameworks:HHG90, |
---|
1621 | keywords = {formal}, |
---|
1622 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1623 | author = {Richard Helm and Ian M. Holland and Dipayan Gangopadhyay}, |
---|
1624 | title = {Contracts: Specifying Behavioural Compositions in Cbject-Oriented Systems}, |
---|
1625 | booktitle = {Proceedings of ACM Symposium on Object-Oriented Programming: Systems, Languages and Applications}, |
---|
1626 | year = 1990, |
---|
1627 | pages = {169-180}, |
---|
1628 | } |
---|
1629 | |
---|
1630 | @article{Wand80, |
---|
1631 | keywords = {concurrency, continuation}, |
---|
1632 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1633 | author = {Mitchell Wand}, |
---|
1634 | title = {Continuation-Based Multiprocessing}, |
---|
1635 | publisher = {The Lisp Conference}, |
---|
1636 | journal = {Conference Record of the 1980 Lisp Conference}, |
---|
1637 | pages = {19-28}, |
---|
1638 | year = 1980, |
---|
1639 | } |
---|
1640 | |
---|
1641 | @article{Hieb90, |
---|
1642 | keywords = {continuations, concurrency}, |
---|
1643 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1644 | author = {Robert Hieb and R. Kent Dybvig}, |
---|
1645 | title = {Continuations and Concurrency}, |
---|
1646 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
1647 | volume = 25, |
---|
1648 | number = 3, |
---|
1649 | month = mar, |
---|
1650 | year = 1990, |
---|
1651 | pages = {128-136}, |
---|
1652 | note = {Proceedings of the Second ACM SIGPLAN Symposium on Principles \& Practise of Parallel Programming, |
---|
1653 | March. 14--16, 1990, Seattle, Washington, U.S.A}, |
---|
1654 | } |
---|
1655 | |
---|
1656 | @inproceedings{Haynes84, |
---|
1657 | keywords = {continuations, coroutines, Scheme}, |
---|
1658 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1659 | author = {Christopher T. Haynes and Daniel P. Friedman and Mitchell Wand}, |
---|
1660 | title = {Continuations and Coroutines}, |
---|
1661 | booktitle = {Conference Record of the 1984 {ACM} Symposium on Lisp and Functional Programming}, |
---|
1662 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery}, |
---|
1663 | month = aug, |
---|
1664 | year = 1984, |
---|
1665 | pages = {293-298}, |
---|
1666 | abstract = { |
---|
1667 | The power of first class continuations is demonstrated by implementing |
---|
1668 | a variety of coroutine mechanisms using only continuations and |
---|
1669 | functional abstraction. The importance of general abstraction |
---|
1670 | mechanisms such as continuations is discussed.}, |
---|
1671 | } |
---|
1672 | |
---|
1673 | @inproceedings{Zahn74, |
---|
1674 | keywords = {goto, structured programming}, |
---|
1675 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1676 | author = {C. T. Zahn}, |
---|
1677 | title = {Control Statement for Natural Top-down Structured Programming}, |
---|
1678 | booktitle = {Symposium on Programming Languages}, |
---|
1679 | address = {Paris, France}, |
---|
1680 | year = 1974, |
---|
1681 | } |
---|
1682 | |
---|
1683 | @unpublished{Ditchfield:conversions, |
---|
1684 | contributer = {a3moss@uwaterloo.ca}, |
---|
1685 | author = {Glen Ditchfield}, |
---|
1686 | title = {Conversions for {Cforall}}, |
---|
1687 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/~cforall/Conversions/index.html}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-\textasciitilde cforall/\-Conversions/\-index.html}}, |
---|
1688 | month = {Nov}, |
---|
1689 | year = {2002}, |
---|
1690 | urldate = {28 July 2016}, |
---|
1691 | } |
---|
1692 | |
---|
1693 | @techreport{Dijkstra65, |
---|
1694 | keywords = {concurrency, Dekker's algorithm, semaphores}, |
---|
1695 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1696 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra}, |
---|
1697 | title = {Cooperating Sequential Processes}, |
---|
1698 | institution = {Technological University}, |
---|
1699 | address = {Eindhoven, Netherlands}, |
---|
1700 | year = 1965, |
---|
1701 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{Genuys68} pp. 43--112.} |
---|
1702 | } |
---|
1703 | |
---|
1704 | @book{Marlin80, |
---|
1705 | keywords = {coroutines}, |
---|
1706 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1707 | author = {Christopher D. Marlin}, |
---|
1708 | title = {Coroutines: A Programming Methodology, a Language Design and an Implementation}, |
---|
1709 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
1710 | address = {New York}, |
---|
1711 | year = 1980, |
---|
1712 | volume = 95, |
---|
1713 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science, Ed. by G. Goos and J. Hartmanis} |
---|
1714 | } |
---|
1715 | |
---|
1716 | @article{Wang71, |
---|
1717 | keywords = {coroutines}, |
---|
1718 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1719 | author = {Arne Wang and Ole-Johan Dahl}, |
---|
1720 | title = {Coroutine Sequencing in a Block Structured Environment}, |
---|
1721 | journal = "BIT", |
---|
1722 | volume = 11, |
---|
1723 | month = nov, |
---|
1724 | year = 1971, |
---|
1725 | pages = {425-449}, |
---|
1726 | } |
---|
1727 | |
---|
1728 | @article{Castagna95, |
---|
1729 | keywords = {type-systems, covariance, contravariance}, |
---|
1730 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1731 | author = {Giuseppe Castagna}, |
---|
1732 | title = {Covariance and Contravariance : Conflict without a Cause}, |
---|
1733 | journal = toplas, |
---|
1734 | volume = 17, |
---|
1735 | number = 3, |
---|
1736 | month = may, |
---|
1737 | year = 1995, |
---|
1738 | pages = {341-447}, |
---|
1739 | } |
---|
1740 | |
---|
1741 | @book{Fischer88, |
---|
1742 | keywords = {compiler construction}, |
---|
1743 | author = {Charles N. Fischer and Richard J. {LeBlanc, Jr.}}, |
---|
1744 | title = {Crafting a Compiler}, |
---|
1745 | publisher = {Benjamin Cummings}, |
---|
1746 | year = 1991, |
---|
1747 | } |
---|
1748 | |
---|
1749 | @article{Moore75, |
---|
1750 | keywords = {approximation methods, integrated circuits}, |
---|
1751 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1752 | author = {Gordon E. Moore}, |
---|
1753 | title = {Progress in Digital Integrated Electronics}, |
---|
1754 | journal = {Technical Digest, International Electron Devices Meeting, IEEE}, |
---|
1755 | year = 1975, |
---|
1756 | pages = {11-13}, |
---|
1757 | } |
---|
1758 | |
---|
1759 | @inproceedings{Jim02, |
---|
1760 | keywords = {C dialect, parametric polymorphic, safe memory allocation}, |
---|
1761 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1762 | author = {Trevor Jim and Greg Morrisett and Dan Grossman and Michael Hicks and James Cheney and and Yanling Wang}, |
---|
1763 | title = {{C}yclone: A Safe Dialect of {C}}, |
---|
1764 | booktitle = {USENIX Annual Technical Conference}, |
---|
1765 | organization= {USENIX Association}, |
---|
1766 | address = {Monterey, California, U.S.A.}, |
---|
1767 | month = jun, |
---|
1768 | year = 2002, |
---|
1769 | pages = {275-288}, |
---|
1770 | } |
---|
1771 | |
---|
1772 | % D |
---|
1773 | |
---|
1774 | @manual{D, |
---|
1775 | keywords = {D programming language}, |
---|
1776 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1777 | title = {{D} Programming Language}, |
---|
1778 | author = {Walter Bright and Andrei Alexandrescu}, |
---|
1779 | organization= {Digital Mars}, |
---|
1780 | year = 2016, |
---|
1781 | note = {\href{http://dlang.org/spec/spec.html}{http://\-dlang.org/\-spec/\-spec.html}}, |
---|
1782 | } |
---|
1783 | |
---|
1784 | @techreport{Cui90, |
---|
1785 | keywords = {exception handling}, |
---|
1786 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1787 | author = {Qian Cui}, |
---|
1788 | title = {Data-Oriented Exception Handling}, |
---|
1789 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, University of Maryland}, |
---|
1790 | address = {College Park, Maryland, U.S.A., 20742}, |
---|
1791 | number = {CS-TR-2384}, |
---|
1792 | month = jan, |
---|
1793 | year = 1990, |
---|
1794 | } |
---|
1795 | |
---|
1796 | @article{Cui92, |
---|
1797 | contributer = {rkrische@plg}, |
---|
1798 | author = {Qian Cui and John Gannon}, |
---|
1799 | title = {Data-oriented Exception Handling}, |
---|
1800 | journal = {IEEE Transactions on Software Engineering}, |
---|
1801 | month = may, |
---|
1802 | year = 1992, |
---|
1803 | volume = 18, |
---|
1804 | number = 5, |
---|
1805 | pages = {393-401}, |
---|
1806 | } |
---|
1807 | |
---|
1808 | @manual{SIMULA87, |
---|
1809 | keywords = {Simula standard}, |
---|
1810 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1811 | title = {Databehandling -- Programspr{\aa}k -- {SIMULA}}, |
---|
1812 | organization= {Standardiseringskommissionen i Sverige}, |
---|
1813 | note = {Svensk Standard SS 63 61 14}, |
---|
1814 | year = 1987, |
---|
1815 | abstract = { |
---|
1816 | Standard for the programming language SIMULA. Written in English. |
---|
1817 | } |
---|
1818 | } |
---|
1819 | |
---|
1820 | @article{Liskov75, |
---|
1821 | keywords = {abstract data types, encapsulation, verification}, |
---|
1822 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1823 | author = {Barbara H. Liskov}, |
---|
1824 | title = {Data Types and Program Correctness}, |
---|
1825 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
1826 | year = 1975, |
---|
1827 | month = jul, |
---|
1828 | volume = 10, |
---|
1829 | number = 7, |
---|
1830 | pages = {16-17}, |
---|
1831 | summary = { |
---|
1832 | Type definitions should contain the implementation of the type and |
---|
1833 | its operations. The grouping makes programs simpler and more |
---|
1834 | understandable. Encapsulating the definition aids verification and |
---|
1835 | forces a precise specification of the interface. |
---|
1836 | } |
---|
1837 | } |
---|
1838 | |
---|
1839 | @article{dtav, |
---|
1840 | keywords = {Russell, types}, |
---|
1841 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1842 | author = {James Donahue and Alan Demers}, |
---|
1843 | title = {Data Types are Values}, |
---|
1844 | journal = toplas, |
---|
1845 | month = jul, |
---|
1846 | year = 1985, |
---|
1847 | volume = 7, |
---|
1848 | number = 3, |
---|
1849 | pages = {426-445}, |
---|
1850 | comment = { |
---|
1851 | Data types are sets of operations providing interpretations of |
---|
1852 | values from a meaningless, typeless universal value space. Types |
---|
1853 | and operations are also contained in this value space. |
---|
1854 | |
---|
1855 | Functions returning types replace generic types. |
---|
1856 | |
---|
1857 | Polymorphic functions have type parameters. Evaluation is not |
---|
1858 | macro expansion: |
---|
1859 | \begin{verbatim} |
---|
1860 | R == func [n:val integer; T:type[]] val integer |
---|
1861 | {if n > 0 => r[n-1, Array[1,10,T]] # n <= 0 => 17 fi} |
---|
1862 | \end{verbatim} |
---|
1863 | } |
---|
1864 | } |
---|
1865 | |
---|
1866 | @article{Holt72, |
---|
1867 | keywords = {concurrency, deadlock}, |
---|
1868 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1869 | author = {Richard C. Holt}, |
---|
1870 | title = {Some Deadlock Properties of Computer Systems}, |
---|
1871 | journal = acmcs, |
---|
1872 | volume = 4, |
---|
1873 | number = 3, |
---|
1874 | month = sep, |
---|
1875 | year = 1972, |
---|
1876 | pages = {179-196}, |
---|
1877 | } |
---|
1878 | |
---|
1879 | @misc{debug-malloc, |
---|
1880 | keywords = {memory allocation debugger}, |
---|
1881 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1882 | author = {Conor P. Cahill}, |
---|
1883 | title = {debug\_malloc}, |
---|
1884 | howpublished= {comp.sources.unix, volume 22, issue 112}, |
---|
1885 | abstract = { |
---|
1886 | This package is a collection of routines which are a drop-in |
---|
1887 | replacement for the malloc(3), memory(3), string(3), and bstring(3) |
---|
1888 | library functions. |
---|
1889 | } |
---|
1890 | } |
---|
1891 | |
---|
1892 | @book{sml, |
---|
1893 | keywords = {}, |
---|
1894 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1895 | author = {Robin Milner and Mads Tofte and Robert Harper}, |
---|
1896 | title = {The Definition of Standard {ML}}, |
---|
1897 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
1898 | address = {Cambridge}, |
---|
1899 | year = 1990 |
---|
1900 | } |
---|
1901 | |
---|
1902 | @techreport{sml:old, |
---|
1903 | keywords = {}, |
---|
1904 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1905 | author = {Robert Harper and Robin Milner and Mads Tofte}, |
---|
1906 | title = {The Definition of Standard {ML}, Version 2}, |
---|
1907 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, University of Edinburgh}, |
---|
1908 | year = 1988, |
---|
1909 | address = {The King's Buildings, Edinburgh EH9 3JZ}, |
---|
1910 | type = {LFCS Report Series}, month = aug, number = {ECS-LFCS-88-62} |
---|
1911 | } |
---|
1912 | |
---|
1913 | @inproceedings{Reynolds72, |
---|
1914 | keywords = {continuation}, |
---|
1915 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1916 | author = {John Reynolds}, |
---|
1917 | title = {Definitional Interpreters for Higher Order Programming Languages}, |
---|
1918 | booktitle = {ACM Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
1919 | organization= {ACM}, |
---|
1920 | year = 1972, |
---|
1921 | pages = {717-740} |
---|
1922 | } |
---|
1923 | |
---|
1924 | @article{Buhr16, |
---|
1925 | keywords = {Dekker's algorithm, software solution, mutual exclusion, performance experiment}, |
---|
1926 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and David Dice and Wim H. Hesselink}, |
---|
1927 | title = {Dekker's Mutual Exclusion Algorithm Made RW-Safe}, |
---|
1928 | journal = ccpe, |
---|
1929 | volume = 28, |
---|
1930 | number = 1, |
---|
1931 | pages = {144-165}, |
---|
1932 | month = jan, |
---|
1933 | year = 2016, |
---|
1934 | } |
---|
1935 | |
---|
1936 | @misc{steelman, |
---|
1937 | keywords = {Ada}, |
---|
1938 | contributer = {gjditchfied@plg}, |
---|
1939 | author = {High Order Language Working Group}, |
---|
1940 | title = {Department of Defense Requirements for High Order Computer Programming Languages}, |
---|
1941 | month = jun, year = 1978, |
---|
1942 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{pldesign}.} |
---|
1943 | } |
---|
1944 | |
---|
1945 | @incollection{Tsay98, |
---|
1946 | keywords = {local spins, mutual exclusion, read/write atomicity, refinement, scalability}, |
---|
1947 | author = {Yih-Kuen Tsay}, |
---|
1948 | title = {Deriving a scalable algorithm for mutual exclusion}, |
---|
1949 | booktitle = {Distributed Computing}, |
---|
1950 | editor = {Shay Kutten}, |
---|
1951 | volume = {1499}, |
---|
1952 | series = {LNCS}, |
---|
1953 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
1954 | address = {Berlin Heidelberg}, |
---|
1955 | year = {1998}, |
---|
1956 | pages = {393-407}, |
---|
1957 | } |
---|
1958 | |
---|
1959 | @article{Conway63, |
---|
1960 | keywords = {coroutine, original}, |
---|
1961 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
1962 | author = {Melvin E. Conway}, |
---|
1963 | title = {Design of a Separable Transition-Diagram Compiler}, |
---|
1964 | journal = cacm, |
---|
1965 | month = jul, |
---|
1966 | year = 1963, |
---|
1967 | volume = 6, |
---|
1968 | number = 7, |
---|
1969 | pages = {396-408}, |
---|
1970 | } |
---|
1971 | |
---|
1972 | @book{Stroustrup94, |
---|
1973 | keywords = {C++}, |
---|
1974 | contributor = {wyrmok@plg}, |
---|
1975 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
1976 | title = {The Design and Evolution of {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
1977 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
1978 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
1979 | year = 1994 |
---|
1980 | } |
---|
1981 | |
---|
1982 | @inproceedings{st:concurrent, |
---|
1983 | keywords = {concurrency, Smalltalk, futures}, |
---|
1984 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
1985 | author = {Yasuhiko Yokote and Mario Tokoro}, |
---|
1986 | title = {The Design and Implementation of {ConcurrentSmalltalk}}, |
---|
1987 | crossref = "OOPSLA86", |
---|
1988 | pages = {331-340}, |
---|
1989 | comment = { |
---|
1990 | Objects are ordinary Smalltalk objects or ``atomic'' objects, which |
---|
1991 | process messages one at a time in FIFO order. Asynchronous method |
---|
1992 | calls are made by appending ``\&'' at the call site. The sender does |
---|
1993 | not wait for a reply. If the method returns a value, it |
---|
1994 | (immediately?) returns a CBox object, which is like a future. The |
---|
1995 | sender can send the ``receive'' message to the CBox, which blocks |
---|
1996 | until the CBox contains a value. |
---|
1997 | |
---|
1998 | A method can execute the ``\verb|^|'' statement to return an object |
---|
1999 | and terminate, or it can execute ``\verb|^^|'' to return an object |
---|
2000 | and continue execution. If ``\verb|^^foo|'' is executed after |
---|
2001 | ``\verb|^^bar|'', foo is discarded, since bar has already been |
---|
2002 | returned. |
---|
2003 | |
---|
2004 | The article does not say whether asynchronous messages can be sent |
---|
2005 | to ordinary objects, or whether ordinary messages can be sent to |
---|
2006 | atomic objects. |
---|
2007 | } |
---|
2008 | } |
---|
2009 | |
---|
2010 | @inproceedings{Ichbiah83, |
---|
2011 | keywords = {Ada, packages, generics}, |
---|
2012 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2013 | author = {Jean D. Ichbiah}, |
---|
2014 | title = {On the Design of {Ada}}, |
---|
2015 | booktitle = {Information Processing 83}, |
---|
2016 | year = 1983, |
---|
2017 | month = sep, pages = {1-10}, |
---|
2018 | editor = {R. E. A. Mason}, |
---|
2019 | organization= {IFIP}, |
---|
2020 | publisher = {North-Holland}, |
---|
2021 | summary = { |
---|
2022 | Packages group related declarations or subprograms, and encapsulate |
---|
2023 | data types. Separate interfaces and bodies promotes information |
---|
2024 | hiding by removing the need to scan the body, allows the body to be |
---|
2025 | confidential, and provides a better specification of the contract |
---|
2026 | between client and implementor. Generics are an efficient way to |
---|
2027 | factor out parts of similar definitions. |
---|
2028 | } |
---|
2029 | } |
---|
2030 | |
---|
2031 | @book{Motet96, |
---|
2032 | keywords = {Ada, exception handling}, |
---|
2033 | contributer = {wyrmok@plg}, |
---|
2034 | author = {G. Motet and A. Mapinard and J. C. Geoffroy}, |
---|
2035 | title = {Design of Dependable {A}da Software}, |
---|
2036 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
2037 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
2038 | year = 1996, |
---|
2039 | } |
---|
2040 | |
---|
2041 | @article{Richardson93, |
---|
2042 | keywords = {C++, persistence, database}, |
---|
2043 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2044 | author = {Joel E. Richardson and Michael J. Carey and Daniel T. Schuh}, |
---|
2045 | title = {The Design of the {E} Programming Language}, |
---|
2046 | journal = toplas, |
---|
2047 | month = jul, |
---|
2048 | year = 1993, |
---|
2049 | volume = 15, |
---|
2050 | number = 3, |
---|
2051 | pages = {494-534}, |
---|
2052 | } |
---|
2053 | |
---|
2054 | @article{Hansen81b, |
---|
2055 | keywords = {concurrency, monitor, critical region}, |
---|
2056 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2057 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}}, |
---|
2058 | title = {The Design of {E}dison}, |
---|
2059 | journal = spe, |
---|
2060 | volume = 11, |
---|
2061 | number = 4, |
---|
2062 | month = apr, |
---|
2063 | year = 1981, |
---|
2064 | pages = {363-396}, |
---|
2065 | } |
---|
2066 | |
---|
2067 | @book{Gamma95, |
---|
2068 | keywords = {design patterns}, |
---|
2069 | author = {Erich Gamma and Richard Helm and Ralph Johnson and John Vlissides}, |
---|
2070 | title = {Design Patterns: Elements of Reusable Object-Oriented Software}, |
---|
2071 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
2072 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
2073 | year = 1995, |
---|
2074 | series = {Professional Computing Series}, |
---|
2075 | } |
---|
2076 | |
---|
2077 | @inproceedings{Wirth74, |
---|
2078 | keywords = {}, |
---|
2079 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2080 | author = {Niklaus Wirth}, |
---|
2081 | title = {On the Design of Programming Languages}, |
---|
2082 | booktitle = {Information Processing 74}, |
---|
2083 | year = 1974, |
---|
2084 | pages = {386-393}, |
---|
2085 | publisher = {North Holland Publishing Company}, |
---|
2086 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{pldesign}.} |
---|
2087 | } |
---|
2088 | |
---|
2089 | @techreport{forceone, |
---|
2090 | keywords = {Parametric polymorphism, ForceOne}, |
---|
2091 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2092 | author = {Andrew K. Wright}, |
---|
2093 | title = {Design of the Programming Language {ForceOne}}, |
---|
2094 | institution = {University of Waterloo}, |
---|
2095 | month = feb, year = 1987, |
---|
2096 | number = {CS-87-10} |
---|
2097 | } |
---|
2098 | |
---|
2099 | @techreport{x-2, |
---|
2100 | keywords = {object based}, |
---|
2101 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2102 | author = {David W. Sandberg}, |
---|
2103 | title = {The Design of the Programming Language {X-2}}, |
---|
2104 | institution = {Oregon State University}, |
---|
2105 | year = 1985, |
---|
2106 | address = {Department of Computer Science, Corvallis, Oregon, 97331}, |
---|
2107 | number = {85-60-1} |
---|
2108 | } |
---|
2109 | |
---|
2110 | @article{design, |
---|
2111 | keywords = {Smalltalk, designing classes}, |
---|
2112 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2113 | author = {Ralph E. Johnson and Brian Foote}, |
---|
2114 | title = {Designing Reusable Classes}, |
---|
2115 | journal = joop, |
---|
2116 | year = 1988, |
---|
2117 | volume = 1, number = 2, pages = {22-35}, |
---|
2118 | comment = { |
---|
2119 | Abstract classes represent standard protocols. ``It is better to |
---|
2120 | inherit from an abstract class than from a concrete class''. |
---|
2121 | Frameworks are collections of related abstract classes. Successful |
---|
2122 | abstractions are discovered, not designed. |
---|
2123 | |
---|
2124 | Protocols: ``If an operation X is implemented by performing a |
---|
2125 | similar operation on the components of the receiver, then that |
---|
2126 | operation should also be named X''. Eliminate case analysis by |
---|
2127 | creating classes with the same operations. Create classes to |
---|
2128 | represent bundles of parameters. Shrink methods larger than 30 |
---|
2129 | lines. |
---|
2130 | |
---|
2131 | Hierarchies should be deep and narrow. Subclasses should be |
---|
2132 | specializations. |
---|
2133 | |
---|
2134 | Frameworks: split large classes. Factor implementation differences |
---|
2135 | into subcomponents. Separate methods that do not share instance |
---|
2136 | variables into components that reflect the different views of the |
---|
2137 | object. Send messages to components, not self. Reduce implicit |
---|
2138 | parameter passing through instance variables. |
---|
2139 | } |
---|
2140 | } |
---|
2141 | |
---|
2142 | @article{dim:c++, |
---|
2143 | keywords = {Dimensional Analysis, C++}, |
---|
2144 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2145 | author = {Robert F. Cmelic and Narain Gehani}, |
---|
2146 | title = {Dimensional Analysis with {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
2147 | journal = {IEEE Software}, |
---|
2148 | month = may, year = 1988, |
---|
2149 | volume = 5, number = 3, pages = {21-29} |
---|
2150 | } |
---|
2151 | |
---|
2152 | @article{Wegner87, |
---|
2153 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2154 | author = {Peter Wegner}, |
---|
2155 | title = {Dimensions of Object--Based Language Design}, |
---|
2156 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
2157 | volume = 22, |
---|
2158 | number = 12, |
---|
2159 | month = dec, |
---|
2160 | year = 1987, |
---|
2161 | pages = {168-182}, |
---|
2162 | note = {Proceedings of the OOPSLA'87 Conference, Oct. 4--8, 1987, Orlando, Florida}, |
---|
2163 | } |
---|
2164 | |
---|
2165 | @book{Dijkstra76, |
---|
2166 | keywords = {concurrent assignment}, |
---|
2167 | author = {E. W. Dijkstra}, |
---|
2168 | title = {A Discipline of Programming}, |
---|
2169 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
2170 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
2171 | year = 1976, |
---|
2172 | } |
---|
2173 | |
---|
2174 | @book{Lynch96, |
---|
2175 | keywords = {distributed algorithms}, |
---|
2176 | author = {Nancy A. Lynch}, |
---|
2177 | title = {Distributed Algorithms}, |
---|
2178 | publisher = {Morgan Kaufmann}, |
---|
2179 | year = 1996, |
---|
2180 | } |
---|
2181 | |
---|
2182 | @book{Tanenbaum02, |
---|
2183 | keywords = {distributed programming}, |
---|
2184 | author = {Andrew S. Tanenbaum and Maarten van Steen}, |
---|
2185 | title = {Distributed Systems: Principles and Paradigms}, |
---|
2186 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
2187 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
2188 | year = 2002, |
---|
2189 | } |
---|
2190 | |
---|
2191 | @inproceedings{Cargill90, |
---|
2192 | keywords = {concurrency}, |
---|
2193 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2194 | author = {Tom A. Cargill}, |
---|
2195 | title = {Does {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Really Need Multiple Inheritance?}, |
---|
2196 | booktitle = {USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
2197 | organization= {USENIX Association}, |
---|
2198 | address = {San Francisco, California, U.S.A.}, |
---|
2199 | month = apr, |
---|
2200 | year = 1990, |
---|
2201 | pages = {315-323} |
---|
2202 | } |
---|
2203 | |
---|
2204 | @unpublished{Duff83, |
---|
2205 | keywords = {C, switch statement, control flow}, |
---|
2206 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2207 | author = {Tom Duff}, |
---|
2208 | title = {Duff's Device}, |
---|
2209 | month = nov, |
---|
2210 | year = 1983, |
---|
2211 | note = {\href{http://www.lysator.liu.se/c/duffs-device.html}{http://\-www.lysator.liu.se/\-c/\-duffs-device.html}} |
---|
2212 | } |
---|
2213 | |
---|
2214 | @manual{dwarf2, |
---|
2215 | keywords = {Debugging DWARF2 specification}, |
---|
2216 | contributer = {rkrische@plg}, |
---|
2217 | title = {DWARF Debugging Information Format}, |
---|
2218 | organization= {Unix International Programming Languages SIG}, |
---|
2219 | publisher = {Unix International}, |
---|
2220 | address = {Waterview Corporate Center, 20 Waterview Boulevard, Parsippany, NJ 07054}, |
---|
2221 | year = {1993} |
---|
2222 | } |
---|
2223 | |
---|
2224 | @article{classicada, |
---|
2225 | keywords = {Classic Ada}, |
---|
2226 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2227 | author = {Cameron M. Donaldson}, |
---|
2228 | title = {Dynamic Binding and Inheritance in an Object-Oriented {Ada} Design}, |
---|
2229 | journal = {Journal of Pascal, {Ada} \& Modula-2}, |
---|
2230 | year = 1990, |
---|
2231 | month = {jul/aug}, volume = 9, number = 4, pages = {12-19}, |
---|
2232 | comment = { |
---|
2233 | Classes are like packages: they can contain subprograms, types, |
---|
2234 | variables, generic instantiations, and exceptions. They can also |
---|
2235 | contain class methods, instance methods, and instance variables, |
---|
2236 | and define creation and initialization subprograms or methods for |
---|
2237 | instances. Single inheritance provides inheritance of |
---|
2238 | implementations. Dynamic binding is done with a {\em send} |
---|
2239 | statement that invokes a class or instance method. A preprocessor |
---|
2240 | converts Classic Ada to normal Ada. |
---|
2241 | } |
---|
2242 | } |
---|
2243 | |
---|
2244 | @article{Costanza03, |
---|
2245 | keywords = {dynamic call}, |
---|
2246 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2247 | author = {Pascal Costanza}, |
---|
2248 | title = {Dynamic Scoped Functions as the Essence of {AOP}}, |
---|
2249 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
2250 | volume = 38, |
---|
2251 | number = 8, |
---|
2252 | month = aug, |
---|
2253 | year = 2003, |
---|
2254 | pages = {29-35}, |
---|
2255 | } |
---|
2256 | |
---|
2257 | % E |
---|
2258 | |
---|
2259 | @inproceedings{Wegbreit71, |
---|
2260 | keywords = {polymorphism}, |
---|
2261 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2262 | author = {B. Wegbreit}, |
---|
2263 | title = {The ECL Programming System}, |
---|
2264 | booktitle = {Proceedings of AFIPS 1971 FJCC}, |
---|
2265 | publisher = {AFIPS Press, vol. 39}, |
---|
2266 | address = {Montvale, New Jersey, U.S.A}, |
---|
2267 | year = 1971, |
---|
2268 | pages = {253-262}, |
---|
2269 | } |
---|
2270 | |
---|
2271 | @manual{JavaScript, |
---|
2272 | keywords = {JavaScript}, |
---|
2273 | contributer = {pabuhr}, |
---|
2274 | title = {ECMAScript 2015 Language Specification {JavaScript}}, |
---|
2275 | organization= {ECAM International}, |
---|
2276 | address = {Rue du Rhone 114, CH-1204 Geneva, Switzerland}, |
---|
2277 | month = jun, |
---|
2278 | year = 2015, |
---|
2279 | note = {6th Edition} |
---|
2280 | } |
---|
2281 | |
---|
2282 | @inproceedings{Peterson77, |
---|
2283 | keywords = {N-thread software-solution mutual exclusion}, |
---|
2284 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2285 | author = {Gary L. Peterson and Michael J. Fischer}, |
---|
2286 | title = {Economical Solutions for the Critical Section Problem in a Distributed System (Extended Abstract)}, |
---|
2287 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Ninth Annual ACM Symposium on Theory of Computing}, |
---|
2288 | series = {STOC '77}, |
---|
2289 | year = 1977, |
---|
2290 | location = {Boulder, Colorado, USA}, |
---|
2291 | pages = {91--97}, |
---|
2292 | numpages = {7}, |
---|
2293 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
2294 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
2295 | } |
---|
2296 | |
---|
2297 | @article{Hansen81a, |
---|
2298 | keywords = {concurrency, monitor, critical region}, |
---|
2299 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2300 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}}, |
---|
2301 | title = {{E}dison---a Multiprocessor Language}, |
---|
2302 | journal = spe, |
---|
2303 | volume = 11, |
---|
2304 | number = 4, |
---|
2305 | month = apr, |
---|
2306 | year = {1981}, |
---|
2307 | pages = {325-361}, |
---|
2308 | } |
---|
2309 | |
---|
2310 | @book{Eiffel, |
---|
2311 | keywords = {Eiffel}, |
---|
2312 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2313 | author = {Bertrand Meyer}, |
---|
2314 | title = {Eiffel: The Language}, |
---|
2315 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
2316 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
2317 | year = 1992, |
---|
2318 | series = {Prentice-Hall Object-Oriented Series}, |
---|
2319 | } |
---|
2320 | |
---|
2321 | @article{WS:overload, |
---|
2322 | keywords = {compilation}, |
---|
2323 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2324 | author = {Peter J. L. Wallis and Bernhard W. Silverman}, |
---|
2325 | title = {Efficient Implementation of the {Ada} Overloading Rules}, |
---|
2326 | journal = ipl, |
---|
2327 | year = 1980, |
---|
2328 | month = apr, volume = 10, number = 3, pages = {120-123}, |
---|
2329 | comment = { |
---|
2330 | The ``two-pass'' algorithm. An upward pass over a parse tree |
---|
2331 | calculates the set of possible result types of operators. The |
---|
2332 | root must have exactly one type, produced in one way. A |
---|
2333 | downward pass selects the version of the operator that produces the |
---|
2334 | desired result type, thus setting the result types of subtrees. |
---|
2335 | See \cite{D:overload}. |
---|
2336 | } |
---|
2337 | } |
---|
2338 | |
---|
2339 | @techreport{Habermann80, |
---|
2340 | keywords = {Ada, threads}, |
---|
2341 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2342 | author = {A. N. Habermann and I. R. Nassi}, |
---|
2343 | title = {Efficient Implementation of {Ada} Tasks}, |
---|
2344 | institution = {Carnegie-Mellon University}, |
---|
2345 | number = {CMU-CS-80-103}, |
---|
2346 | year = 1980 |
---|
2347 | } |
---|
2348 | |
---|
2349 | @article{Emerald, |
---|
2350 | keywords = {concurrency, polymorphism}, |
---|
2351 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2352 | author = {Rajendra K. Raj and Ewan Tempero and Henry M. Levy and Andrew P. Black and Norman C. Hutchinson and Eric Jul}, |
---|
2353 | title = {Emerald: A General-Purpose Programming Language}, |
---|
2354 | journal = spe, |
---|
2355 | month = jan, |
---|
2356 | year = 1991, |
---|
2357 | volume = 21, |
---|
2358 | number = 1, |
---|
2359 | pages = {91-118} |
---|
2360 | } |
---|
2361 | |
---|
2362 | @InProceedings{chambers89a, |
---|
2363 | keywords = {maps, delegation}, |
---|
2364 | author = "Craig Chambers and David Ungar and Elgin Lee", |
---|
2365 | title = "An Efficient Implementation of {SELF}, a Dynamically-Typed |
---|
2366 | Object-Oriented Language Based on Prototypes", |
---|
2367 | crossref = "OOPSLA89", |
---|
2368 | pages = {49-70} |
---|
2369 | } |
---|
2370 | |
---|
2371 | @article{oop:encapsulation, |
---|
2372 | keywords = {Encapsulation, Inheritance, Subclasses, Multiple Inheritance}, |
---|
2373 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2374 | author = {Alan Snyder}, |
---|
2375 | title = {Encapsulation and Inheritance in Object-Oriented Programming |
---|
2376 | Languages}, |
---|
2377 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
2378 | volume = {21}, number = {11}, |
---|
2379 | pages = {38-45}, |
---|
2380 | month = nov, year = 1986, |
---|
2381 | comment = { |
---|
2382 | Client, child interfaces should be distinct. Child interface |
---|
2383 | shouldn't grant total access to parent. |
---|
2384 | |
---|
2385 | Rules for redefining parent variable name in a child affect |
---|
2386 | re-implementation of the parent. |
---|
2387 | |
---|
2388 | Inheritance can be a promise to obey the semantics of the parent, |
---|
2389 | or code reuse; the two may be contradictory. Unification |
---|
2390 | exposes use of inheritance: a child can not be re-implemented |
---|
2391 | without breaking code that assumes that it is a subclass of the |
---|
2392 | original parent. If a class uses the names of its parents' |
---|
2393 | ancestors, then inheritance is part of the parent's child |
---|
2394 | interface. |
---|
2395 | |
---|
2396 | Linearizing a multiple inheritance tree means that a class's use of |
---|
2397 | calls on super need to be understood before it is used as a parent. |
---|
2398 | Merging repeated ancestors exposes inheritance if an ancestor is |
---|
2399 | re-implemented. Forbidding inheritance of distinct methods with |
---|
2400 | the same name exposes implementation of ancestors. Proposed |
---|
2401 | solution treats the set of ancestors as a tree. |
---|
2402 | } |
---|
2403 | } |
---|
2404 | |
---|
2405 | @article{st:encapsulator, |
---|
2406 | keywords = {encapsulator, Smalltalk, monitor}, |
---|
2407 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2408 | author = {Geoffrey A. Pascoe}, |
---|
2409 | title = {Encapsulators: A New Software Paradigm in Smalltalk-80}, |
---|
2410 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
2411 | volume = {21}, number = {11}, |
---|
2412 | pages = {341-346}, |
---|
2413 | month = nov, year = 1986, |
---|
2414 | comment = { |
---|
2415 | Encapsulators are objects that surround other objects. |
---|
2416 | Pre- and post-actions are performed when messages are sent to the |
---|
2417 | encapsulated object. They are created here by sending the message |
---|
2418 | object: to an encapsulator class. Examples given are monitors, |
---|
2419 | atomic objects, and Model (for model-view-controller interfaces). |
---|
2420 | |
---|
2421 | Encapsulator classes use a family of selectors that the |
---|
2422 | encapsulated object will not respond to. Messages for the |
---|
2423 | encapsulated object are passed on by trapping them with the |
---|
2424 | doesNotUnderstand method. Various fiddles were needed when setting |
---|
2425 | up the class and metaclass hierarchies. A few selectors (==, |
---|
2426 | class) always directly invoke primitive methods; they can't be |
---|
2427 | used. |
---|
2428 | |
---|
2429 | Can an encapsulated object be an encapsulator? Probably, but the |
---|
2430 | middle object's selectors are inaccessible. |
---|
2431 | } |
---|
2432 | } |
---|
2433 | |
---|
2434 | @manual{EPT, |
---|
2435 | keywords = {concurrency, light-weight threads}, |
---|
2436 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2437 | key = {Encore}, |
---|
2438 | title = {Encore Parallel Thread Manual, 724-06210}, |
---|
2439 | organization= {Encore Computer Corporation}, |
---|
2440 | month = may, |
---|
2441 | year = 1988, |
---|
2442 | } |
---|
2443 | |
---|
2444 | @manual{Erlang, |
---|
2445 | keywords = {Erlang}, |
---|
2446 | contributer = {pabuhr}, |
---|
2447 | title = {Erlang Reference Manual User's Guide, Vertion 7.0}, |
---|
2448 | organization= {Erlang/OTP System Documentation}, |
---|
2449 | address = {1430 Broadway, New York, New York 10018}, |
---|
2450 | month = jun, |
---|
2451 | year = 2015, |
---|
2452 | note = {\href{http://www.erlang.org/doc/pdf/otp-system-documentation.pdf}{\textsf{http://www.erlang.org/\-doc/\-pdf/\-otp-system-\-documentation.pdf}}}, |
---|
2453 | } |
---|
2454 | |
---|
2455 | @inproceedings{MH88, |
---|
2456 | keywords = {modules, general sums, general products}, |
---|
2457 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2458 | author = {John C. Mitchell and Robert Harper}, |
---|
2459 | title = {The Essence of {ML}}, |
---|
2460 | booktitle = popl, |
---|
2461 | year = 1988, |
---|
2462 | pages = {28-46} |
---|
2463 | } |
---|
2464 | |
---|
2465 | @book{LeVerrand, |
---|
2466 | keywords = {}, |
---|
2467 | author = {D. Le Verrand}, |
---|
2468 | title = {Evaluating {Ada}}, |
---|
2469 | publisher = {North Oxford Academic}, |
---|
2470 | year = 1985 |
---|
2471 | } |
---|
2472 | |
---|
2473 | @inproceedings{Bloom79, |
---|
2474 | keywords = {concurrency}, |
---|
2475 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2476 | author = {Toby Bloom}, |
---|
2477 | title = {Evaluating Synchronization Mechanisms}, |
---|
2478 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Seventh Symposium on Operating Systems Principles}, |
---|
2479 | organization= {ACM SIGOPS}, |
---|
2480 | address = {Pacific Grove, California, U.S.A}, |
---|
2481 | month = dec, |
---|
2482 | year = 1979, |
---|
2483 | pages = {24-32} |
---|
2484 | } |
---|
2485 | |
---|
2486 | @article{Buhr06a, |
---|
2487 | keywords = {concurrency, C++, uC++}, |
---|
2488 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2489 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Richard C. Bilson}, |
---|
2490 | title = {Examining $\mu${C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} : |
---|
2491 | High-level Object-Oriented Concurrency in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
2492 | journal = {Dr. Dobb's Journal : Software Tools for the Professional Programmer}, |
---|
2493 | month = feb, |
---|
2494 | year = 2006, |
---|
2495 | volume = 31, |
---|
2496 | number = 2, |
---|
2497 | pages = {36-40}, |
---|
2498 | } |
---|
2499 | |
---|
2500 | @article{ExceptionalC, |
---|
2501 | keywords = {exception handling, asynchronous events}, |
---|
2502 | contributer = {wyrmok@plg}, |
---|
2503 | author = {N. H. Gehani}, |
---|
2504 | title = {Exceptional {C} or {C} with Exceptions}, |
---|
2505 | journal = spe, |
---|
2506 | year = 1992, |
---|
2507 | month = oct, |
---|
2508 | volume = 22, |
---|
2509 | number = 10, |
---|
2510 | pages = {827-848}, |
---|
2511 | comment = { |
---|
2512 | It is the most extensive exceptional handling mechanism thus |
---|
2513 | far. Though it doesn't have Mesa resumption, it has |
---|
2514 | asynchronous signal which is more general and abstract than |
---|
2515 | the unix signal mechanism. It has an Eiffel like retry |
---|
2516 | mechanism. Consequently, the scope of guarded region is not |
---|
2517 | immediately terminated when an exception is raised. In fact, |
---|
2518 | an exception handler creates a scope under its guarded |
---|
2519 | region. |
---|
2520 | } |
---|
2521 | } |
---|
2522 | |
---|
2523 | @incollection{Buhr02, |
---|
2524 | keywords = {exception handling}, |
---|
2525 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2526 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Ashif Harji and W. Y. Russell Mok}, |
---|
2527 | title = {Exception Handling}, |
---|
2528 | editor = {Marvin V. Zelkowitz}, |
---|
2529 | booktitle = {Advances in COMPUTERS}, |
---|
2530 | publisher = {Academic Press}, |
---|
2531 | address = {London}, |
---|
2532 | volume = 56, |
---|
2533 | year = 2002, |
---|
2534 | pages = {245-303}, |
---|
2535 | } |
---|
2536 | |
---|
2537 | @article{Cargill94, |
---|
2538 | keywords = {exception handling}, |
---|
2539 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2540 | author = {Tom Cargill}, |
---|
2541 | title = {Exception Handling: a False Sense of Security}, |
---|
2542 | journal = {{C}{\kern-.2em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.2em+}}} Report}, |
---|
2543 | year = 1994, |
---|
2544 | month = nov, |
---|
2545 | volume = 6, |
---|
2546 | number = 9, |
---|
2547 | note = {http://www.informit.com/\-content/\-images/\-020163371x/\-supplements/\-Exception\_\-Handling\_\-Article.\-html} |
---|
2548 | } |
---|
2549 | |
---|
2550 | @article{Knudsen84, |
---|
2551 | keywords = {static exception handling, BETA, sequel}, |
---|
2552 | contributer = {wyrmok@plg}, |
---|
2553 | author = {J{\o}rgen Lindskov Knudsen}, |
---|
2554 | title = {Exception Handling --- A Static Approach}, |
---|
2555 | journal = spe, |
---|
2556 | year = 1984, |
---|
2557 | month = may, |
---|
2558 | volume = 14, |
---|
2559 | number = 5, |
---|
2560 | pages = {429-449}, |
---|
2561 | } |
---|
2562 | |
---|
2563 | @article{Drew94, |
---|
2564 | keywords = {exceptions, exception handling}, |
---|
2565 | contributer = {wyrmok@plg}, |
---|
2566 | author = {Steven J. Drew and K. John Gough}, |
---|
2567 | title = {Exception Handling: Expecting the Unexpected}, |
---|
2568 | journal = {Computer Languages}, |
---|
2569 | year = 1994, |
---|
2570 | month = may, |
---|
2571 | volume = 20, |
---|
2572 | number = 2, |
---|
2573 | comment = { |
---|
2574 | A recent and good survey on various exception handling mechanisms found |
---|
2575 | in imperative programming languages. It classifies various mechanism in |
---|
2576 | terms of flow control and scopes. Asynchronous exceptions and signals |
---|
2577 | are also covered as Exceptional C is in the survey. |
---|
2578 | } |
---|
2579 | } |
---|
2580 | |
---|
2581 | @article{Koenig90, |
---|
2582 | keywords = {exception handling}, |
---|
2583 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2584 | author = {Andrew Koenig and Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
2585 | title = {Exception Handling for {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
2586 | journal = joop, |
---|
2587 | month = {July/August}, |
---|
2588 | year = 1990, |
---|
2589 | volume = 3, |
---|
2590 | number = 2, |
---|
2591 | pages = {16-33}, |
---|
2592 | } |
---|
2593 | |
---|
2594 | @article{Lee83, |
---|
2595 | keywords = {exception handling, C}, |
---|
2596 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2597 | author = {P. A. Lee}, |
---|
2598 | title = {Exception Handling in {C} Programs}, |
---|
2599 | journal = spe, |
---|
2600 | volume = 13, |
---|
2601 | number = 5, |
---|
2602 | month = may, |
---|
2603 | year = 1983, |
---|
2604 | pages = {389-405}, |
---|
2605 | } |
---|
2606 | |
---|
2607 | @article{Liskov79, |
---|
2608 | keywords = {exception handling}, |
---|
2609 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2610 | author = {Barbara H. Liskov and Alan Snyder}, |
---|
2611 | title = {Exception Handling in {CLU}}, |
---|
2612 | journal = ieeese, |
---|
2613 | month = nov, |
---|
2614 | year = 1979, |
---|
2615 | volume = {SE-5}, |
---|
2616 | number = 6, |
---|
2617 | pages = {546-558}, |
---|
2618 | } |
---|
2619 | |
---|
2620 | @article{Szalas85, |
---|
2621 | keywords = {concurrency, C++}, |
---|
2622 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2623 | author = {Andrzej Szalas and Danuta Szczepanska}, |
---|
2624 | title = {Exception Handling in Parallel Computations}, |
---|
2625 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
2626 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
2627 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
2628 | volume = 20, |
---|
2629 | number = 10, |
---|
2630 | month = oct, |
---|
2631 | year = 1985, |
---|
2632 | pages = {95-104}, |
---|
2633 | } |
---|
2634 | |
---|
2635 | @article{MacLaren77, |
---|
2636 | keywords = {exception handling, PL/I}, |
---|
2637 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2638 | author = {M. Donald MacLaren}, |
---|
2639 | title = {Exception Handling in {PL/I}}, |
---|
2640 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
2641 | volume = 12, |
---|
2642 | number = 3, |
---|
2643 | month = mar, |
---|
2644 | year = 1977, |
---|
2645 | pages = {101-104}, |
---|
2646 | note = {Proceedings of an ACM Conference on Language Design for Reliable Software, |
---|
2647 | March 28--30, 1977, Raleigh, North Carolina, U.S.A.}, |
---|
2648 | } |
---|
2649 | |
---|
2650 | @article{Goodenough75, |
---|
2651 | keywords = {exception handling}, |
---|
2652 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2653 | author = {J. B. Goodenough}, |
---|
2654 | title = {Exception Handling: Issues and a Proposed Notation}, |
---|
2655 | journal = cacm, |
---|
2656 | month = dec, |
---|
2657 | year = 1975, |
---|
2658 | volume = 18, |
---|
2659 | number = 12, |
---|
2660 | pages = {683-696}, |
---|
2661 | } |
---|
2662 | |
---|
2663 | @article{Lampson80, |
---|
2664 | keywords = {monitors}, |
---|
2665 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2666 | author = {B. W. Lampson and D. D. Redell}, |
---|
2667 | title = {Experience with Processes and Monitors in Mesa}, |
---|
2668 | journal = cacm, |
---|
2669 | volume = 23, |
---|
2670 | number = 2, |
---|
2671 | month = feb, |
---|
2672 | year = 1980, |
---|
2673 | pages = {105-117}, |
---|
2674 | } |
---|
2675 | |
---|
2676 | @inproceedings{Shopiro87, |
---|
2677 | keywords = {concurrency}, |
---|
2678 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2679 | author = {Jonathan E. Shopiro}, |
---|
2680 | title = {Extending the {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Task System for Real-Time Control}, |
---|
2681 | booktitle = {Proceedings and Additional Papers {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Workshop}, |
---|
2682 | organization= {USENIX Association}, |
---|
2683 | address = {Santa Fe, New Mexico, U.S.A}, |
---|
2684 | month = nov, |
---|
2685 | year = 1987, |
---|
2686 | pages = {77-94} |
---|
2687 | } |
---|
2688 | |
---|
2689 | @article{Modula-2+, |
---|
2690 | keywords = {Modula-2, exceptions, garbage collection, concurrency}, |
---|
2691 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2692 | author = {Paul Rovner}, |
---|
2693 | title = {Extending Modula-2 to Build Large, Integrated Systems}, |
---|
2694 | journal = {IEEE Software}, |
---|
2695 | month = nov, year = 1986, |
---|
2696 | volume = 3, number = 6, pages = {46-57}, |
---|
2697 | comment = { |
---|
2698 | Exceptions can have a parameter. Procedures can declare the |
---|
2699 | exceptions they can propagate; others are converted to {\tt |
---|
2700 | SYSTEM.Fail}. If they don't, all exceptions propagate. |
---|
2701 | Block cleanup statements execute no matter how control leaves the |
---|
2702 | block. |
---|
2703 | |
---|
2704 | {\tt REF t} is a garbage-collected pointer. A {\tt REFANY} can be |
---|
2705 | assigned any {\tt REF t}. Open array types can be used in |
---|
2706 | parameter and {\tt REF} types. {\tt NEW} creates arrays of fixed, |
---|
2707 | dynamically determined size. |
---|
2708 | |
---|
2709 | The {\tt THREAD} module provides lightweight processes, semaphores, |
---|
2710 | and conditions. A statement {\tt LOCK {\em semaphore} DO |
---|
2711 | {\em statements} END} is built in. |
---|
2712 | |
---|
2713 | {\tt SAFE} modules do run-time checks, and only import {\tt |
---|
2714 | SAFE} modules. One implementation module can implement several |
---|
2715 | definition modules. Opaque type implementations can be |
---|
2716 | repeated in modules that import its definition, so implementation |
---|
2717 | modules can collaborate. The linker checks that all |
---|
2718 | implementations are the same. |
---|
2719 | } |
---|
2720 | } |
---|
2721 | |
---|
2722 | @inproceedings{BNRPascal, |
---|
2723 | keywords = {concurrency, rendezvous}, |
---|
2724 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2725 | author = {R. Kamel and N. Gammage}, |
---|
2726 | title = {Experience with Rendezvous}, |
---|
2727 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 1988 International Conference on Computer Languages}, |
---|
2728 | month = oct, |
---|
2729 | year = 1988, |
---|
2730 | pages = {143-149} |
---|
2731 | } |
---|
2732 | |
---|
2733 | % F |
---|
2734 | |
---|
2735 | @inproceedings{Knudsen01, |
---|
2736 | keywords = {Beta, exception handling}, |
---|
2737 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2738 | author = {J{\o}rgen Lindskov Knudsen}, |
---|
2739 | title = {Fault Tolerance and Exception Handling in {BETA}}, |
---|
2740 | booktitle = {Exception Handling}, |
---|
2741 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
2742 | volume = 2022, |
---|
2743 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science}, |
---|
2744 | year = 2001, |
---|
2745 | pages = {1-17} |
---|
2746 | } |
---|
2747 | |
---|
2748 | @article{Lamport87, |
---|
2749 | keywords = {software solutions, mutual exclusion, fast}, |
---|
2750 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2751 | author = {Leslie Lamport}, |
---|
2752 | title = {A Fast Mutual Exclusion Algorithm}, |
---|
2753 | journal = tocs, |
---|
2754 | volume = 5, |
---|
2755 | number = 1, |
---|
2756 | month = jan, |
---|
2757 | year = {1987}, |
---|
2758 | pages = {1--11}, |
---|
2759 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
2760 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
2761 | } |
---|
2762 | |
---|
2763 | @inproceedings{F-bound, |
---|
2764 | keywords = {}, |
---|
2765 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2766 | author = {Peter Canning and William Cook and Walter Hill and Walter Olthoff and John C. Mitchell}, |
---|
2767 | title = {F-Bounded Polymorphism for Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
2768 | booktitle = {Fourth International Conference on Functional Programming Languages and Computer Architecture}, |
---|
2769 | year = 1989, |
---|
2770 | month = sep, |
---|
2771 | pages = {273-280} |
---|
2772 | } |
---|
2773 | |
---|
2774 | @mastersthesis{Wasik08, |
---|
2775 | author = {Ayelet Wasik}, |
---|
2776 | title = {Features of a Multi-Threaded Memory Allocator}, |
---|
2777 | school = {University of Waterloo}, |
---|
2778 | year = 2008, |
---|
2779 | month = jan, |
---|
2780 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
2781 | note = {\textsf{http://uwspace.uwaterloo.ca/\-bitstream/\-10012/\-3501/\-1/\-Thesis.pdf}}, |
---|
2782 | } |
---|
2783 | |
---|
2784 | @article{Holzmann94, |
---|
2785 | keywords = {semaphore, flags}, |
---|
2786 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2787 | author = {Gerard J. Holzmann and Bj\"{o}rn Pehrson}, |
---|
2788 | title = {The First Data Networks}, |
---|
2789 | journal = {Scientific American}, |
---|
2790 | month = jan, |
---|
2791 | year = 1994, |
---|
2792 | volume = 12, |
---|
2793 | number = 1, |
---|
2794 | pages = {124-129}, |
---|
2795 | } |
---|
2796 | |
---|
2797 | @article{Bohm66, |
---|
2798 | keywords = {goto, structured programming}, |
---|
2799 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2800 | author = {C. B\"{o}hm and G. Jacopini}, |
---|
2801 | title = {Flow diagrams, Turing Machines and Languages with only two Formation Rules}, |
---|
2802 | journal = cacm, |
---|
2803 | month = may, |
---|
2804 | year = 1966, |
---|
2805 | volume = 9, |
---|
2806 | number = 5, |
---|
2807 | pages = {366-371}, |
---|
2808 | } |
---|
2809 | |
---|
2810 | @manual{Fortran95, |
---|
2811 | keywords = {Fortran 95}, |
---|
2812 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2813 | key = {Fortran95}, |
---|
2814 | title = {Fortran 95 Standard, ISO/IEC 1539}, |
---|
2815 | organization = {Unicomp, Inc.}, |
---|
2816 | address = {7660 E. Broadway, Tucson, Arizona, U.S.A, 85710}, |
---|
2817 | month = jan, |
---|
2818 | year = 1997, |
---|
2819 | } |
---|
2820 | |
---|
2821 | @manual{Fortran08, |
---|
2822 | keywords = {ISO/IEC Fortran 08}, |
---|
2823 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2824 | key = {Fortran08}, |
---|
2825 | title = {Programming Languages -- {Fortran} Part 1}, |
---|
2826 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 1989:2014}, |
---|
2827 | publisher = {International Standard Organization}, |
---|
2828 | address = {http://www.iso.org}, |
---|
2829 | year = 2010, |
---|
2830 | } |
---|
2831 | |
---|
2832 | @book{Andrews00:book, |
---|
2833 | keywords = {concurrency}, |
---|
2834 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2835 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews}, |
---|
2836 | title = {Foundations of Multithreaded, Parallel and Distributed Programming}, |
---|
2837 | publisher = {Addison--Wesley}, |
---|
2838 | year = 2000, |
---|
2839 | } |
---|
2840 | |
---|
2841 | @article{Agha89, |
---|
2842 | keywords = {actors, concurrency}, |
---|
2843 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2844 | author = {Gul A. Agha}, |
---|
2845 | title = {Foundational Issues in Concurrent Computing}, |
---|
2846 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
2847 | month = apr, |
---|
2848 | year = 1989, |
---|
2849 | volume = 24, |
---|
2850 | number = 4, |
---|
2851 | pages = {60-65}, |
---|
2852 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN Workshop on Object-Based Concurrent Programming, |
---|
2853 | Sept. 26--27, 1988, San Diego, California, U.S.A}, |
---|
2854 | } |
---|
2855 | |
---|
2856 | @article{ool, |
---|
2857 | keywords = {}, |
---|
2858 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2859 | author = {Douglas T. Ross}, |
---|
2860 | title = {Toward Foundations for the Understanding of Type}, |
---|
2861 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
2862 | year = 1976, |
---|
2863 | volume = 11, pages = {63-65}, |
---|
2864 | note = {Conference on Data: Abstraction, Definition and Structure}, |
---|
2865 | summary = { |
---|
2866 | Possibly the first use (without definition, alas) of the phrase |
---|
2867 | "object oriented language". Metaphysical to the point of incoherence. |
---|
2868 | } |
---|
2869 | } |
---|
2870 | |
---|
2871 | @article{frames, |
---|
2872 | keywords = {frames}, |
---|
2873 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2874 | author = {Paul G. Basset}, |
---|
2875 | title = {Frame-Based Software Engineering}, |
---|
2876 | journal = {IEEE Software}, |
---|
2877 | month = jul, year = 1987, |
---|
2878 | volume = 4, number = 4, pages = {9-16} |
---|
2879 | } |
---|
2880 | |
---|
2881 | @article{Sutter05, |
---|
2882 | keywords = {concurrency, C++}, |
---|
2883 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2884 | author = {Herb Sutter}, |
---|
2885 | title = {A Fundamental Turn Toward Concurrency in Software}, |
---|
2886 | journal = {Dr. Dobb's Journal : Software Tools for the Professional Programmer}, |
---|
2887 | month = mar, |
---|
2888 | year = 2005, |
---|
2889 | volume = 30, |
---|
2890 | number = 3, |
---|
2891 | pages = {16-22}, |
---|
2892 | } |
---|
2893 | |
---|
2894 | @inproceedings{Dony01, |
---|
2895 | keywords = {Smalltalk, exception handling}, |
---|
2896 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2897 | author = {Chistophe Dony}, |
---|
2898 | title = {A Fully Object-Oriented Exception Handling System: Rationale and Smalltalk Implementation}, |
---|
2899 | booktitle = {Exception Handling}, |
---|
2900 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
2901 | volume = 2022, |
---|
2902 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science}, |
---|
2903 | year = 2001, |
---|
2904 | pages = {18-38} |
---|
2905 | } |
---|
2906 | |
---|
2907 | @misc{FW, |
---|
2908 | key = {FW}, |
---|
2909 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2910 | title = {Funk \& Wagnalls Standard Desk Dictionary}, |
---|
2911 | year = 1980 |
---|
2912 | } |
---|
2913 | |
---|
2914 | @book{Knuth73V1, |
---|
2915 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2916 | author = {Donald E. Knuth}, |
---|
2917 | title = {Fundamental Algorithms}, |
---|
2918 | series = {The Art of Computer Programming}, |
---|
2919 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
2920 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
2921 | year = 1973, |
---|
2922 | volume = 1, |
---|
2923 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
2924 | } |
---|
2925 | |
---|
2926 | @inproceedings{Strachey, |
---|
2927 | keywords = {polymorphism}, |
---|
2928 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2929 | author = {C. Strachey}, |
---|
2930 | title = {Fundamental Concepts in Programming Languages}, |
---|
2931 | booktitle = {Lecture Notes for the International Summer School in Computer Programming}, |
---|
2932 | year = 1967, |
---|
2933 | month = aug, |
---|
2934 | address = {Copenhagen}, |
---|
2935 | comment = { |
---|
2936 | Defines ad-hoc and parametric polymorphism. |
---|
2937 | } |
---|
2938 | } |
---|
2939 | |
---|
2940 | @article{Eisenberg72, |
---|
2941 | keywords = {concurrency, N-Process solution, O(N)}, |
---|
2942 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
2943 | author = {Murray A. Eisenberg and Michael R. McGuire}, |
---|
2944 | title = {Further Comments on {D}ijkstra's Concurrent Programming Control Problem}, |
---|
2945 | journal = cacm, |
---|
2946 | month = nov, |
---|
2947 | year = 1972, |
---|
2948 | volume = 15, |
---|
2949 | number = 11, |
---|
2950 | pages = {999}, |
---|
2951 | } |
---|
2952 | |
---|
2953 | % G |
---|
2954 | |
---|
2955 | @article{Boehm88, |
---|
2956 | keywords = {conservative garbage collection, C}, |
---|
2957 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2958 | author = {Hans-Juergen Boehm and Mark Weiser}, |
---|
2959 | title = {Garbage Collection in an Uncooperative Environment}, |
---|
2960 | journal = spe, |
---|
2961 | month = sep, |
---|
2962 | year = 1988, |
---|
2963 | volume = 18, |
---|
2964 | number = 9, |
---|
2965 | pages = {807-820} |
---|
2966 | } |
---|
2967 | |
---|
2968 | @manual{gcc, |
---|
2969 | keywords = {}, |
---|
2970 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2971 | title = {GCC}, |
---|
2972 | author = {Richard M. Stallman}, |
---|
2973 | organization= {Free Software Foundation}, |
---|
2974 | address = {Cambridge} |
---|
2975 | } |
---|
2976 | |
---|
2977 | @article{doUpon, |
---|
2978 | keywords = {formal verification, axiomatic semantics, control structures}, |
---|
2979 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
2980 | author = {Ed Anson}, |
---|
2981 | title = {A Generalized Iterative Construct and Its Semantics}, |
---|
2982 | journal = toplas, |
---|
2983 | volume = {9}, number = {4}, |
---|
2984 | pages = {567-581}, |
---|
2985 | month = oct, year = 1987, |
---|
2986 | comment = { |
---|
2987 | \begin{verbatim} |
---|
2988 | do |
---|
2989 | P1 -> L1 |
---|
2990 | [] P2 -> L2 |
---|
2991 | ... |
---|
2992 | [] Pm -> Lm |
---|
2993 | upon |
---|
2994 | Q1 -> M1 |
---|
2995 | [] Q2 -> M2 |
---|
2996 | ... |
---|
2997 | [] qn -> mn |
---|
2998 | od |
---|
2999 | \end{verbatim} |
---|
3000 | |
---|
3001 | If there is an i such that Qi is true, execute Mi and terminate. |
---|
3002 | Otherwise, if there is an i such that Pi is true, execute Li and |
---|
3003 | repeat the loop. Otherwise, fail. |
---|
3004 | } |
---|
3005 | } |
---|
3006 | |
---|
3007 | @unpublished{Bilson, |
---|
3008 | keywords = {generic programming, generics, polymorphism}, |
---|
3009 | contributor = {a3moss@plg}, |
---|
3010 | author = {Richard C. Bilson and Glen Ditchfield and Peter A. Buhr}, |
---|
3011 | title = {Generic Programming with Inferred Models}, |
---|
3012 | } |
---|
3013 | |
---|
3014 | @article{Haskell, |
---|
3015 | keywords = {lazy evaluation, type class}, |
---|
3016 | contributer = {pabuhr}, |
---|
3017 | author = {Paul Hudak and Joseph H. Fasel}, |
---|
3018 | title = {A Gentle Introduction to Haskell}, |
---|
3019 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
3020 | volume = 27, |
---|
3021 | number = 5, |
---|
3022 | month = may, |
---|
3023 | year = 1992, |
---|
3024 | pages = {T1-53}, |
---|
3025 | } |
---|
3026 | |
---|
3027 | @manual{Go, |
---|
3028 | keywords = {Go programming language}, |
---|
3029 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3030 | title = {{Go} Programming Language}, |
---|
3031 | author = {Robert Griesemer and Rob Pike and Ken Thompson}, |
---|
3032 | organization= {Google}, |
---|
3033 | year = 2009, |
---|
3034 | note = {\href{http://golang.org/ref/spec}{http://\-golang.org/\-ref/\-spec}}, |
---|
3035 | } |
---|
3036 | |
---|
3037 | @article{Dijkstra68a, |
---|
3038 | keywords = {goto}, |
---|
3039 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3040 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra}, |
---|
3041 | title = {Go To Statement Considered Harmful}, |
---|
3042 | journal = cacm, |
---|
3043 | month = mar, |
---|
3044 | year = 1968, |
---|
3045 | volume = 11, |
---|
3046 | number = 3, |
---|
3047 | pages = {147-148}, |
---|
3048 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{Yourdon79} pp. 29--36.}, |
---|
3049 | } |
---|
3050 | |
---|
3051 | @article{Choi91, |
---|
3052 | keywords = {contra-variance, functions}, |
---|
3053 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3054 | author = {Injun Choi and Michael V. Mannino}, |
---|
3055 | title = {Graph Interpretation of Methods: A Unifying Framework for Polymorphism in Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
3056 | journal = {OOPS Messenger}, |
---|
3057 | volume = 2, |
---|
3058 | number = 1, |
---|
3059 | month = jan, |
---|
3060 | year = 1991, |
---|
3061 | pages = {38-54}, |
---|
3062 | } |
---|
3063 | |
---|
3064 | @misc{GNU-C, |
---|
3065 | keywords = {C, ANSI C}, |
---|
3066 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3067 | author = {Richard Stallman}, |
---|
3068 | title = {The Free Software Foundation's Gnu {C} Compiler}, |
---|
3069 | howpublished= {Free Software Foundation, 1000 Mass Ave., Cambridge, MA, U.S.A., 02138}, |
---|
3070 | year = 1989, |
---|
3071 | } |
---|
3072 | |
---|
3073 | @article{Dijkstra:green, |
---|
3074 | keywords = {ada}, |
---|
3075 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3076 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra}, |
---|
3077 | title = {On the GREEN Language submitted to the DoD}, |
---|
3078 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
3079 | year = 1978, |
---|
3080 | month = oct, |
---|
3081 | volume = 13, |
---|
3082 | number = 10, |
---|
3083 | pages = {16-21} |
---|
3084 | } |
---|
3085 | |
---|
3086 | @inproceedings{Miller02, |
---|
3087 | keywords = {exception handling}, |
---|
3088 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3089 | author = {Robert Miller and Anand Tripathi}, |
---|
3090 | title = {The Guardian Model for Exception Handling in Distributed Systems}, |
---|
3091 | booktitle = {21st Symposium on Reliable Distributed Systems}, |
---|
3092 | organization= {IEEE}, |
---|
3093 | address = {Suita, Japan}, |
---|
3094 | year = 2002, |
---|
3095 | month = oct, |
---|
3096 | pages = {304-313} |
---|
3097 | } |
---|
3098 | |
---|
3099 | @phdthesis{Chen09, |
---|
3100 | author = {Jun Chen}, |
---|
3101 | title = {Guided Testing of Concurrent Programs Using Value Schedules}, |
---|
3102 | school = {University of Waterloo}, |
---|
3103 | year = 2009, |
---|
3104 | month = sep, |
---|
3105 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
3106 | note = {\textsf{http://uwspace.uwaterloo.ca/bitstream/\-10012/\-4735/\-1/\-Chen-Jun.pdf}}, |
---|
3107 | } |
---|
3108 | |
---|
3109 | @misc{GNU-C++, |
---|
3110 | keywords = {C++, GNU C}, |
---|
3111 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3112 | author = {Michael D. Tiemann}, |
---|
3113 | title = {User's Guide to GNU {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
3114 | howpublished= {Free Software Foundation, 1000 Mass Ave., Cambridge, MA, U.S.A., 02138}, |
---|
3115 | month = mar, |
---|
3116 | year = 1990, |
---|
3117 | } |
---|
3118 | |
---|
3119 | % H |
---|
3120 | |
---|
3121 | @article{Michael04a, |
---|
3122 | keywords = {Lock-free, synchronization, concurrent programming, memory management, multiprogramming, dynamic data structures}, |
---|
3123 | author = {Maged M. Michael}, |
---|
3124 | title = {Hazard Pointers: Safe Memory Reclamation for Lock-Free Objects}, |
---|
3125 | journal = ieeepds, |
---|
3126 | volume = 15, |
---|
3127 | number = 6, |
---|
3128 | month = jun, |
---|
3129 | year = 2004, |
---|
3130 | pages = {491-504}, |
---|
3131 | publisher = {IEEE Press}, |
---|
3132 | address = {Piscataway, NJ, USA}, |
---|
3133 | } |
---|
3134 | |
---|
3135 | @techreport{Hermes90, |
---|
3136 | keywords = {processes, distributed computing}, |
---|
3137 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3138 | author = {Robert E. Strom and David F. Bacon and Arthur P. Goldberg and Andy Lowry and Daniel M. Yellin and Shaula Alexander Yemini}, |
---|
3139 | title = {Hermes: A Language for Distributed Computing}, |
---|
3140 | institution = {IBM T. J. Watson Research Center}, |
---|
3141 | address = {Yorktown Heights, New York, U.S.A., 10598}, |
---|
3142 | month = oct, |
---|
3143 | year = 1990, |
---|
3144 | } |
---|
3145 | |
---|
3146 | @book{Hermes91, |
---|
3147 | keywords = {processes, distributed computing}, |
---|
3148 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3149 | author = {Robert E. Strom and David F. Bacon and Arthur P. Goldberg and Andy Lowry and Daniel M. Yellin and Shaula Alexander Yemini}, |
---|
3150 | title = {Hermes: A Language for Distributed Computing}, |
---|
3151 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
3152 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
3153 | series = {Innovative Technology}, |
---|
3154 | year = 1991, |
---|
3155 | } |
---|
3156 | |
---|
3157 | @article{katzenelson83b, |
---|
3158 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3159 | author = "Jacob Katzenelsen", |
---|
3160 | title = "Higher Level Programming and Data Abstraction---A Case Study using Enhanced C", |
---|
3161 | journal = spe, |
---|
3162 | year = 1983, |
---|
3163 | volume = 13, |
---|
3164 | number = 7, |
---|
3165 | pages = {577-596}, |
---|
3166 | month = jul |
---|
3167 | } |
---|
3168 | |
---|
3169 | @techreport{Hoare73, |
---|
3170 | keywords = {}, |
---|
3171 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3172 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare}, |
---|
3173 | title = {Hints on Programming Language Design}, |
---|
3174 | institution = {Stanford University Computer Science Department}, |
---|
3175 | year = 1973, |
---|
3176 | month = dec, |
---|
3177 | number = {CS-73-403}, |
---|
3178 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{pldesign}.} |
---|
3179 | } |
---|
3180 | |
---|
3181 | @article{Dijkstra71, |
---|
3182 | keywords = {monitor, secretary}, |
---|
3183 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3184 | author = {E. W. Dijkstra}, |
---|
3185 | title = {Hierarchical Ordering of Sequential Processes}, |
---|
3186 | journal = acta, |
---|
3187 | volume = 1, |
---|
3188 | pages = {115-138}, |
---|
3189 | year = 1971, |
---|
3190 | } |
---|
3191 | |
---|
3192 | @article{Buhr15a, |
---|
3193 | keywords = {software solution, mutual exclusion, performance experiment}, |
---|
3194 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and David Dice and Wim H. Hesselink}, |
---|
3195 | title = {High-Performance {$N$}-Thread Software Solutions for Mutual Exclusion}, |
---|
3196 | journal = ccpe, |
---|
3197 | volume = 27, |
---|
3198 | number = 3, |
---|
3199 | pages = {651-701}, |
---|
3200 | month = mar, |
---|
3201 | year = 2015, |
---|
3202 | } |
---|
3203 | |
---|
3204 | @article{Ackermann28, |
---|
3205 | keywords = {recursion, Ackermann function}, |
---|
3206 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3207 | author = {Wilhelm Ackermann}, |
---|
3208 | title = {Zum Hilbertschen Aufbau der reellen Zahlen}, |
---|
3209 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
3210 | journal = mathann, |
---|
3211 | number = 1, |
---|
3212 | volume = 99, |
---|
3213 | pages = {118-133}, |
---|
3214 | month = dec, |
---|
3215 | year = 1928, |
---|
3216 | } |
---|
3217 | |
---|
3218 | @inproceedings{typeclass, |
---|
3219 | keywords = {Hindley/Miller type systems, Haskell}, |
---|
3220 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3221 | author = {Philip Wadler and Stephen Blott}, |
---|
3222 | title = {How to make {\em Ad-Hoc} Polymorphism Less {\em Ad-Hoc}}, |
---|
3223 | booktitle = popl, |
---|
3224 | year = 1989, |
---|
3225 | pages = {60-76}, |
---|
3226 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery} |
---|
3227 | } |
---|
3228 | |
---|
3229 | % I |
---|
3230 | |
---|
3231 | @book{IBM370, |
---|
3232 | keywords = {370, IBM}, |
---|
3233 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3234 | key = {IBM370}, |
---|
3235 | title = {{IBM} System/370 Principles of Operation}, |
---|
3236 | publisher = {IBM}, |
---|
3237 | number = {GA22-7000-8}, |
---|
3238 | month = oct, |
---|
3239 | year = 1981, |
---|
3240 | edition = {9th} |
---|
3241 | } |
---|
3242 | |
---|
3243 | @book{Icon, |
---|
3244 | keywords = {Icon}, |
---|
3245 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3246 | author = {Ralph E. Griswold and Madge T. Griswold}, |
---|
3247 | title = {The Icon Programming Language}, |
---|
3248 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
3249 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
3250 | year = 1983, |
---|
3251 | } |
---|
3252 | |
---|
3253 | @inproceedings{Valois94, |
---|
3254 | keywords = {lock free, queue}, |
---|
3255 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3256 | author = {John D. Valois}, |
---|
3257 | title = {Implementing Lock-Free Queues}, |
---|
3258 | booktitle = {Seventh International Conference on Parallel and Distributed Computing Systems}, |
---|
3259 | address = {Las Vegas, Nevada, U.S.A.}, |
---|
3260 | year = {1994}, |
---|
3261 | pages = {64-69}, |
---|
3262 | } |
---|
3263 | |
---|
3264 | @article{Hehner81, |
---|
3265 | keywords = {concurrency, critical section, bakery algorithm}, |
---|
3266 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3267 | author = {Eric C. R. Hehner and R. K. Shyamasundar}, |
---|
3268 | title = {An Implementation of {P} and {V}}, |
---|
3269 | journal = ipl, |
---|
3270 | year = 1981, |
---|
3271 | month = aug, |
---|
3272 | volume = 12, |
---|
3273 | number = 4, |
---|
3274 | pages = {196-198}, |
---|
3275 | } |
---|
3276 | |
---|
3277 | @incollection{Steenkiste91, |
---|
3278 | keywords = {lisp}, |
---|
3279 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3280 | author = {Peter A. Steenkiste}, |
---|
3281 | title = {The Implementation of Tags and Run-Time Checking}, |
---|
3282 | booktitle = {Topics in Advanced Language Implementation}, |
---|
3283 | pages = {3-24}, |
---|
3284 | year = 1991, |
---|
3285 | editor = {Peter Lee}, |
---|
3286 | chapter = {1}, |
---|
3287 | publisher = {The MIT Press} |
---|
3288 | } |
---|
3289 | |
---|
3290 | @techreport{Roberts89, |
---|
3291 | keywords = {}, |
---|
3292 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3293 | author = {Eric S. Roberts}, |
---|
3294 | title = {Implementing Exceptions in {C}}, |
---|
3295 | institution = {Digital Systems Research Center}, |
---|
3296 | address = {130 Lytton Avenue, Palo Alto, California, 94301}, |
---|
3297 | number = {40}, |
---|
3298 | month = mar, |
---|
3299 | year = 1989, |
---|
3300 | } |
---|
3301 | |
---|
3302 | @mastersthesis{Bilson03, |
---|
3303 | keywords = {Cforall, parametric polymorphism, overloading}, |
---|
3304 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3305 | author = {Richard C. Bilson}, |
---|
3306 | title = {Implementing Overloading and Polymorphism in Cforall}, |
---|
3307 | school = {School of Computer Science, University of Waterloo}, |
---|
3308 | year = 2003, |
---|
3309 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
3310 | note = {\href{http://plg.uwaterloo.ca/theses/BilsonThesis.pdf}{http://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-theses/\-BilsonThesis.pdf}}, |
---|
3311 | } |
---|
3312 | |
---|
3313 | @article{Buhr05b, |
---|
3314 | keywords = {monitor, automatic signal, implicit signal}, |
---|
3315 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3316 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Ashif S. Harji}, |
---|
3317 | title = {Implicit-signal monitors}, |
---|
3318 | journal = toplas, |
---|
3319 | volume = 27, |
---|
3320 | number = 6, |
---|
3321 | month = nov, |
---|
3322 | year = 2005, |
---|
3323 | issn = {0164-0925}, |
---|
3324 | pages = {1270--1343}, |
---|
3325 | publisher = {ACM Press}, |
---|
3326 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
3327 | } |
---|
3328 | |
---|
3329 | @article{Baker77, |
---|
3330 | author = {Henry C. Baker, Jr. and Carl Hewitt}, |
---|
3331 | title = {The Incremental Garbage Collection of Processes}, |
---|
3332 | journal = {SIGART Bulletin}, |
---|
3333 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
3334 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
3335 | month = aug, |
---|
3336 | year = 1977, |
---|
3337 | pages = {55-59}, |
---|
3338 | issn = {0163-5719}, |
---|
3339 | } |
---|
3340 | |
---|
3341 | @book{Algol68, |
---|
3342 | keywords = {Algol68}, |
---|
3343 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3344 | author = {C. H. Lindsey and S. G. van der Meulen}, |
---|
3345 | title = {Informal Introduction to ALGOL 68}, |
---|
3346 | publisher = {North-Holland}, |
---|
3347 | address = {London}, |
---|
3348 | year = 1977, |
---|
3349 | } |
---|
3350 | |
---|
3351 | @inproceedings{Cook90, |
---|
3352 | keywords = {f-bounded polymorhpism, lambda calculus}, |
---|
3353 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3354 | author = {William R. Cook and Walter L. Hill and Peter S. Canning}, |
---|
3355 | title = {Inheritance is Not Subtyping}, |
---|
3356 | booktitle = popl, |
---|
3357 | year = 1990, |
---|
3358 | pages = {125-135}, |
---|
3359 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery}, |
---|
3360 | abstract = { |
---|
3361 | In typed object-oriented languages the subtype relation is |
---|
3362 | typically based on the inheritance hierarchy. This approach, |
---|
3363 | however, leads either to insecure type-systems or to restrictions |
---|
3364 | on inheritance that make it less flexible than untyped Smalltalk |
---|
3365 | inheritance. We present a new typed model of inheritance that |
---|
3366 | allows more of the flexibility of Smalltalk inheritance within a |
---|
3367 | statically-typed system. Significant features of our analysis are |
---|
3368 | the introduction of polymorphism into the typing of inheritance and |
---|
3369 | the uniform application of inheritance to objects, classes and |
---|
3370 | types. The resulting notion of {\em type inheritance} allows us to |
---|
3371 | show that the type of an inherited object is an inherited type but |
---|
3372 | not always a subtype. |
---|
3373 | } |
---|
3374 | } |
---|
3375 | |
---|
3376 | @inproceedings{MMR92, |
---|
3377 | keywords = {}, |
---|
3378 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3379 | author = {Robert E. Minnear and Patrick A. Muckelbauer and Vincent F. Russo}, |
---|
3380 | title = {Integrating the {Sun Microsystems} {XDR/RPC} Protocols |
---|
3381 | into the {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Stream Model}, |
---|
3382 | booktitle = {USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
3383 | year = 1992, |
---|
3384 | month = aug, |
---|
3385 | pages = {295-312}, |
---|
3386 | organization= {USENIX Association}, |
---|
3387 | address = {2590 Ninth Street, Suite 215, Berkeley, CA 94710}, |
---|
3388 | abstract = { |
---|
3389 | This paper reports our experiences integrating the Sun Microsystems |
---|
3390 | RPC and XDR protocol specifications into the C++ model of |
---|
3391 | input/output streams. As part of the {\it Renaissance} operating |
---|
3392 | system project, we wish to construct network servers and clients, |
---|
3393 | written in C++, which interoperate with existing UNIX clients |
---|
3394 | and servers. We discovered that, although it would be possible to |
---|
3395 | re-implement the procedural based XDR/RPC implementation |
---|
3396 | distributed by Sun Microsystems in C++, it is far cleaner to |
---|
3397 | integrate the protocols with the C++ I/O stream model. We |
---|
3398 | feel the resulting model provides a cleaner way of implementing RPC |
---|
3399 | clients and servers without losing functionality or compatibility |
---|
3400 | with existing clients and servers. |
---|
3401 | } |
---|
3402 | } |
---|
3403 | |
---|
3404 | @inproceedings{Zuo08, |
---|
3405 | keywords = {shared memory systems,intelligent multiport memory,multiprocessors systems,shared memory system}, |
---|
3406 | author = {Wang Zuo and Wang Zuo and Li Jiaxing}, |
---|
3407 | title = {An Intelligent Multi-Port Memory}, |
---|
3408 | booktitle = {Symposium on Intelligent Information Technology Application Workshops, Shanghai, China}, |
---|
3409 | month = dec, |
---|
3410 | year = 2008, |
---|
3411 | pages = {251-254}, |
---|
3412 | publisher = {IEEE Computer Society}, |
---|
3413 | address = {Los Alamitos, CA, USA}, |
---|
3414 | } |
---|
3415 | |
---|
3416 | @book{Francez96, |
---|
3417 | keywords = {await, formal}, |
---|
3418 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3419 | author = {Nissim Francez and Ira R. Forman}, |
---|
3420 | title = {Interacting Processes: A Multiparty Approach to Coordinated Distributed Programming}, |
---|
3421 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
3422 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
3423 | series = {ACM Press Books}, |
---|
3424 | year = 1996, |
---|
3425 | } |
---|
3426 | |
---|
3427 | @article{Labreche90, |
---|
3428 | keywords = {concurrency, C++}, |
---|
3429 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3430 | author = {Pierre Labr{\`{e}}che}, |
---|
3431 | title = {Interactors: A Real-Time Executive with Multiparty Interactions in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
3432 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
3433 | volume = 25, |
---|
3434 | number = 4, |
---|
3435 | month = apr, |
---|
3436 | year = 1990, |
---|
3437 | pages = {20-32}, |
---|
3438 | } |
---|
3439 | |
---|
3440 | @inproceedings{interfaces, |
---|
3441 | keywords = {parameterized interfaces, classes, recursion/inheritance}, |
---|
3442 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3443 | author = {Peter S. Canning and William R. Cook and Walter L. Hill and |
---|
3444 | Walter G. Olthoff}, |
---|
3445 | title = {Interfaces for Strongly-Typed Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
3446 | crossref = "OOPSLA89", |
---|
3447 | pages = {457-467}, |
---|
3448 | abstract = { |
---|
3449 | This paper develops a system of explicit interfaces for |
---|
3450 | object-oriented programming. The system provides the benefits of |
---|
3451 | module interfaces found in languages like Ada and Modula-2 while |
---|
3452 | preserving the expressiveness that gives untyped object-oriented |
---|
3453 | languages like Smalltalk their flexibility. Interfaces are |
---|
3454 | interpreted as polymorphic types to make the system sufficiently |
---|
3455 | powerful. We use interfaces to analyze the properties of |
---|
3456 | inheritance, and identify three distinct kinds of inheritance in |
---|
3457 | object-oriented programming, corresponding to objects, classes, and |
---|
3458 | interfaces, respectively. Object interfaces clarify the |
---|
3459 | distinction between interface containment and inheritance and give |
---|
3460 | insight into limitations caused by equating the notions of type and |
---|
3461 | class in many typed object-oriented programming languages. |
---|
3462 | Interfaces also have practical consequences for design, |
---|
3463 | specification, and maintenance of object-oriented systems. |
---|
3464 | } |
---|
3465 | } |
---|
3466 | |
---|
3467 | @phdthesis{Girard72, |
---|
3468 | keywords = {universal quantification}, |
---|
3469 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3470 | author = {J.-Y. Girard}, |
---|
3471 | title = {Interpretation fonctionelle et elimination des coupures de |
---|
3472 | l'arithmetique d'ordre superieur}, |
---|
3473 | school = {Universite Paris}, |
---|
3474 | year = {1972} |
---|
3475 | } |
---|
3476 | |
---|
3477 | @article{Karaorman93, |
---|
3478 | keywords = {Eiffel, concurrency libraries}, |
---|
3479 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3480 | author = {Murat Karaorman and John Bruno}, |
---|
3481 | title = {Introducing Concurrency to a Sequential Language}, |
---|
3482 | journal = cacm, |
---|
3483 | month = sep, |
---|
3484 | year = 1993, |
---|
3485 | volume = 36, |
---|
3486 | number = 9, |
---|
3487 | pages = {103-116} |
---|
3488 | } |
---|
3489 | |
---|
3490 | @book{Corman92, |
---|
3491 | keywords = {PRAM, parallel algorithms}, |
---|
3492 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3493 | author = {Thomas H. Cormen and Charles E. Leiserson and Ronald L. Rivest}, |
---|
3494 | title = {Introduction to Algorithms}, |
---|
3495 | publisher = {MIT Press/McGraw-Hill}, |
---|
3496 | address = {Cambridge}, |
---|
3497 | series = {Electrical Engineering and Computer Science Series}, |
---|
3498 | year = 1992, |
---|
3499 | } |
---|
3500 | |
---|
3501 | @book{Hopcroft79, |
---|
3502 | keywords = {finite-state machine, push-dowm automata}, |
---|
3503 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3504 | author = {John E. Hopcroft and Jeffrey D. Ullman}, |
---|
3505 | title = {Introduction to Automata Theory, Languages and Computation}, |
---|
3506 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
3507 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
3508 | year = 1979, |
---|
3509 | } |
---|
3510 | |
---|
3511 | @techreport{walker87, |
---|
3512 | keywords = {CCS}, |
---|
3513 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3514 | author = {David Walker}, |
---|
3515 | title = {Introduction to a Calculus of Communicating Systems}, |
---|
3516 | institution = {Laboratory for Foundations of Computer Science}, |
---|
3517 | year = 1987, |
---|
3518 | address = {Department of Computer Science, University of Edinburgh, Edinburgh EH9 3JZ}, |
---|
3519 | month = jun, |
---|
3520 | number = {ECS-LFCS-87-22}, |
---|
3521 | } |
---|
3522 | |
---|
3523 | @article{katzenelson83a, |
---|
3524 | author = {Jacob Katzenelson}, |
---|
3525 | title = {Introduction to Enhanced C (EC)}, |
---|
3526 | journal = spe, |
---|
3527 | volume = 13, |
---|
3528 | number = 7, |
---|
3529 | year = 1983, |
---|
3530 | month = jul, |
---|
3531 | pages = {551-576}, |
---|
3532 | } |
---|
3533 | |
---|
3534 | @book{Deitel90, |
---|
3535 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems}, |
---|
3536 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3537 | author = {Harvey M. Deitel}, |
---|
3538 | title = {An Introduction to Operating Systems}, |
---|
3539 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
3540 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
3541 | year = 1990, |
---|
3542 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
3543 | } |
---|
3544 | |
---|
3545 | @techreport{Birrell89, |
---|
3546 | keywords = {threads, monitors}, |
---|
3547 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3548 | author = {Andrew D. Birrell}, |
---|
3549 | title = {An Introduction to Programming with Threads}, |
---|
3550 | institution = {Digital Systems Research Center}, |
---|
3551 | address = {130 Lytton Avenue, Palo Alto, California, 94301}, |
---|
3552 | number = {35}, |
---|
3553 | month = jan, |
---|
3554 | year = 1989, |
---|
3555 | note = {{\textsf{http://www.hpl.hp.com/\-techreports/\-Compaq-DEC/\-SRC-RR-35.html}}}, |
---|
3556 | |
---|
3557 | } |
---|
3558 | |
---|
3559 | @article{t/o, |
---|
3560 | keywords = {Trellis/Owl}, |
---|
3561 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3562 | author = {Craig Schaffert and Topher Cooper and Bruce Bullis and Mike Kilian and Carrie Wilpot}, |
---|
3563 | title = {An Introduction to Trellis/Owl}, |
---|
3564 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
3565 | volume = 21, |
---|
3566 | number = 11, |
---|
3567 | year = 1986, |
---|
3568 | month = nov, |
---|
3569 | pages = {9-16}, |
---|
3570 | } |
---|
3571 | |
---|
3572 | @inproceedings{Hibbard77, |
---|
3573 | keywords = {algol-68, concurrency}, |
---|
3574 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3575 | author = {Peter G. Hibbard and P. Knueven and B. W. Leverett}, |
---|
3576 | title = {Issues in the Efficient Implementation and Use of Multiprocessing in {Algol} 68}, |
---|
3577 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 5th Annual iii Conference}, |
---|
3578 | address = {Guidel, France}, |
---|
3579 | month = may, |
---|
3580 | year = 1977, |
---|
3581 | pages = {203-221} |
---|
3582 | } |
---|
3583 | |
---|
3584 | @inproceedings{Miller97, |
---|
3585 | keywords = {exception handling, software-engineering}, |
---|
3586 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3587 | author = {Robert Miller and Anand Tripathi}, |
---|
3588 | title = {Issues with Exception Hnadling in Object-Oriented Systems}, |
---|
3589 | booktitle = {ECOOP'97}, |
---|
3590 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
3591 | volume = 1241, |
---|
3592 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science}, |
---|
3593 | year = 1997, |
---|
3594 | pages = {85-103} |
---|
3595 | } |
---|
3596 | |
---|
3597 | @article{Murer96, |
---|
3598 | keywords = {interators, generators, cursors}, |
---|
3599 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3600 | author = {Stephan Murer and Stephen Omohundro and David Stoutamire and Clemens Szyperski}, |
---|
3601 | title = {Iteration Abstraction in Sather}, |
---|
3602 | journal = toplas, |
---|
3603 | month = jan, |
---|
3604 | year = 1996, |
---|
3605 | volume = 18, |
---|
3606 | number = 1, |
---|
3607 | pages = {1-15}, |
---|
3608 | } |
---|
3609 | |
---|
3610 | % J |
---|
3611 | |
---|
3612 | @book{Java, |
---|
3613 | keywords = {Java}, |
---|
3614 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3615 | author = {James Gosling and Bill Joy and Guy Steele and Gilad Bracha}, |
---|
3616 | title = {The {Java} Language Specification}, |
---|
3617 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
3618 | address = {Reading}, |
---|
3619 | year = 2000, |
---|
3620 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
3621 | } |
---|
3622 | |
---|
3623 | @manual{Java8, |
---|
3624 | keywords = {Java SE 8}, |
---|
3625 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3626 | author = {James Gosling and Bill Joy and Guy Steele and Gilad Bracha and Alex Buckley}, |
---|
3627 | title = {The {Java} Language Specification}, |
---|
3628 | publisher = {Oracle}, |
---|
3629 | year = 2015, |
---|
3630 | edition = {Java SE 8}, |
---|
3631 | } |
---|
3632 | |
---|
3633 | @manual{JUC, |
---|
3634 | keywords = {Java concurrency library}, |
---|
3635 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3636 | title = {java.util.concurrency}, |
---|
3637 | author = {Doug Lea}, |
---|
3638 | organization= {Oracle}, |
---|
3639 | year = 2014, |
---|
3640 | note = {\href{http://docs.oracle.com/javase/7/docs/api/java/util/concurrent/package-summary.html}{\textsf{http://docs.oracle.com/\-javase/7/\-docs/\-api/\-java/\-util/\-concurrent/\-package-summary.html}}}, |
---|
3641 | } |
---|
3642 | |
---|
3643 | % K |
---|
3644 | |
---|
3645 | @article{Duggan96, |
---|
3646 | keywords = {concurrency, critical section}, |
---|
3647 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3648 | author = {Dominic Duggan and Gordon V. Cormack and John Ophel}, |
---|
3649 | title = {Kinded Type Inference for Parametric Overloading}, |
---|
3650 | journal = acta, |
---|
3651 | volume = 33, |
---|
3652 | number = 1, |
---|
3653 | year = 1996, |
---|
3654 | pages = {21-68}, |
---|
3655 | } |
---|
3656 | |
---|
3657 | @article{Peter35, |
---|
3658 | keywords = {recursion, Ackermann function}, |
---|
3659 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3660 | author = {R{\'{o}}zsa P{\'{e}}ter}, |
---|
3661 | title = {Konstruktion nichtrekursiver Funktionen}, |
---|
3662 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
3663 | journal = mathann, |
---|
3664 | number = 111, |
---|
3665 | volume = 1, |
---|
3666 | pages = {42-60}, |
---|
3667 | month = dec, |
---|
3668 | year = 1935, |
---|
3669 | } |
---|
3670 | |
---|
3671 | % L |
---|
3672 | |
---|
3673 | @TechReport{WVWR88:L, |
---|
3674 | contributer = {gjditchf@plg}, |
---|
3675 | author = {Hanno Wupper and Jan Vytopil and Martin Wieczorek and Dick de Reus}, |
---|
3676 | title = {{L}_{3333}: A Simple Language with Static Typing of Hard Real-Time Constraints}, |
---|
3677 | institution = {Department of Informatics, Faculty of Science, Catholic University Nijmegen}, |
---|
3678 | year = 1988, |
---|
3679 | number = {88-3}, |
---|
3680 | address = {Katholieke Universiteit Nijmegen, Fakulteit der Wiskunde |
---|
3681 | en Natuurwetenschappen, Infomatica V, Toernooiveld, 6512 |
---|
3682 | ED Nijmegen, The Netherlands}, |
---|
3683 | month = apr, |
---|
3684 | annote = {A polymorphic typed lambda calculus with \begin{itemize} |
---|
3685 | \item A trivial type, ``!'', with a single element. |
---|
3686 | \item Labelled types, distinct from each other. |
---|
3687 | ``!False'' and ``!True'' are distinct types, each |
---|
3688 | containing a single value serving as boolean false and |
---|
3689 | true. ``2'' is an abbreviation for ``!0 succ succ'', the |
---|
3690 | type containing only 2. |
---|
3691 | \item Disjunction types ``\{| !False, !True |\}''. Interval |
---|
3692 | types are abbreviations for disjunctions. |
---|
3693 | \item Conjunction types ``\{\& real Re, real Im \&\}'', where |
---|
3694 | ``Re'' and ``Im'' are type labels that distinguish between the |
---|
3695 | fields. |
---|
3696 | \item Pair types ``\{^ a, b ^\}'', for use in recursive types |
---|
3697 | and dyadic infix functions. |
---|
3698 | \item Function types, universal types, existential types, |
---|
3699 | and subtyping (viewed as coercion), as in Fun. |
---|
3700 | \end{itemize} |
---|
3701 | Disjunctions and conjunctions types are associative and |
---|
3702 | commutative (i.e. flat). Each type has a matching |
---|
3703 | constructor. Functions use pattern matching on type |
---|
3704 | labels to strip labels and extract conjunction fields: |
---|
3705 | \begin{verbatim} |
---|
3706 | \lambda n {0...1000000 Guilders}. ... n ... |
---|
3707 | -- both argument and n are amounts in Guilders. |
---|
3708 | \lambda n {0...1000000} Guilders. ... n ... |
---|
3709 | -- argument in Guilders, but n is in 0...1000000. |
---|
3710 | \end{verbatim} |
---|
3711 | ``Function bundles'' (conjunctions of functions), applied |
---|
3712 | to arguments, replace Dijkstra's guarded if...fi, but the |
---|
3713 | bundles are first-class and the guards are part of their |
---|
3714 | type. |
---|
3715 | |
---|
3716 | The same trick used to define the type ``2'' is used to |
---|
3717 | move absolute times into the type system, to allow static |
---|
3718 | checking. ``0`'' denotes a time before the system begins |
---|
3719 | execution. ``\#`'' denotes ``eventually'', and ``?`'' |
---|
3720 | denotes ``maybe never''. ``a\\t'' and ``a@t'' are types |
---|
3721 | of a value of type a that will be available no later |
---|
3722 | (earlier) than time t. Universals and existentials use |
---|
3723 | subtyping to parameterize functions by start time: |
---|
3724 | \begin{verbatim} |
---|
3725 | let f {\forall t > \#`}. {a\t} \on {b\t+d} |
---|
3726 | f{then} y -- argument y must be available at time ``then''. |
---|
3727 | \end{verbatim} |
---|
3728 | Functions can return before their arguments are available |
---|
3729 | if they don't use them. However, function {\em bundles} |
---|
3730 | can't return until their result type is known, so the |
---|
3731 | lower and upper time bounds of the bundle are the |
---|
3732 | second-last upper bound of the component functions: at |
---|
3733 | that time, there is only one alternative left. |
---|
3734 | |
---|
3735 | Explicit time parameterization allows slack in time |
---|
3736 | specification. Tools could point out slack or determine |
---|
3737 | degree of parallelism.} |
---|
3738 | } |
---|
3739 | |
---|
3740 | @mastersthesis{Clarke90, |
---|
3741 | keywords = {concurrency, postponing requests}, |
---|
3742 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3743 | author = {Charles L. A. Clarke}, |
---|
3744 | title = {Language and Compiler Support for Synchronous Message Passing Architectures}, |
---|
3745 | school = {University of Waterloo}, |
---|
3746 | year = 1990, |
---|
3747 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1} |
---|
3748 | } |
---|
3749 | |
---|
3750 | @article{Tennent77, |
---|
3751 | keywords = {abstraction, correspondence, Pascal}, |
---|
3752 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3753 | author = {R. D. Tennent}, |
---|
3754 | title = {Language Design Methods Based on Semantic Principles}, |
---|
3755 | journal = acta, |
---|
3756 | year = 1977, |
---|
3757 | volume = 8, |
---|
3758 | number = 2, |
---|
3759 | pages = {97-112}, |
---|
3760 | note = {reprinted in \cite{pldesign}}, |
---|
3761 | abstract = { |
---|
3762 | Two language design methods based on principles derived from the |
---|
3763 | denotational approach to programming language semantics are |
---|
3764 | described and illustrated by an application to the language Pascal. |
---|
3765 | The principles are, firstly, the correspondence between parametric |
---|
3766 | and declarative mechanisms and secondly, a principle of abstraction |
---|
3767 | for programming languages adapted from set theory. Several useful |
---|
3768 | extensions and generalizations of Pascal emerge by applying these |
---|
3769 | principles, including a solution to the array parameter problem, |
---|
3770 | and a modularization facility. |
---|
3771 | }, |
---|
3772 | } |
---|
3773 | |
---|
3774 | @article{Liskov86, |
---|
3775 | keywords = {synchronous communication, concurrency}, |
---|
3776 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3777 | author = {Barbara Liskov and Maurice Kerlihy and Lucy Gilbert}, |
---|
3778 | title = {Limitations of Synchronous Communication with Static |
---|
3779 | Process Structure in Languages for Distributed Computing}, |
---|
3780 | journal = {}, |
---|
3781 | volume = {}, |
---|
3782 | number = {}, |
---|
3783 | month = {}, |
---|
3784 | year = {}, |
---|
3785 | pages = {}, |
---|
3786 | } |
---|
3787 | |
---|
3788 | @article{Linda, |
---|
3789 | keywords = {Linda, concurrency}, |
---|
3790 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3791 | author = {Nicholas Carriero and David Gelernter}, |
---|
3792 | title = {Linda in Context}, |
---|
3793 | journal = cacm, |
---|
3794 | volume = 32, |
---|
3795 | number = 4, |
---|
3796 | month = apr, |
---|
3797 | year = 1989, |
---|
3798 | pages = {444-458} |
---|
3799 | } |
---|
3800 | |
---|
3801 | @book{Weissman67, |
---|
3802 | keywords = {lisp}, |
---|
3803 | author = {Clark Weissman}, |
---|
3804 | title = {Lisp 1.5 Primer}, |
---|
3805 | publisher = {Dickenson Publishing}, |
---|
3806 | address = {Belmont}, |
---|
3807 | year = 1967, |
---|
3808 | } |
---|
3809 | |
---|
3810 | @article{Sundell08, |
---|
3811 | keywords = {lock free, deque}, |
---|
3812 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3813 | author = {H{\r{a}}kan Sundell and Philippas Tsigas}, |
---|
3814 | title = {Lock-free Deques and Doubly Linked Lists}, |
---|
3815 | journal = {J. Parallel Distrib. Comput.}, |
---|
3816 | volume = 68, |
---|
3817 | number = 7, |
---|
3818 | year = 2008, |
---|
3819 | pages = {1008-1020}, |
---|
3820 | } |
---|
3821 | |
---|
3822 | @article{Cormack89, |
---|
3823 | keywords = {parsing, LR, error recovery}, |
---|
3824 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3825 | author = {Gordon V. Cormack}, |
---|
3826 | title = {An {LR} Substring Parser for Noncorrecting Syntax Error Recovery}, |
---|
3827 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
3828 | volume = 24, |
---|
3829 | number = 7, |
---|
3830 | month = jul, |
---|
3831 | year = 1989, |
---|
3832 | pages = {161-169}, |
---|
3833 | note = {Proceedings of the {SIGPLAN}~'89 Conference on Programming Language Design and Implementation} |
---|
3834 | } |
---|
3835 | |
---|
3836 | % M |
---|
3837 | |
---|
3838 | @book{M68K, |
---|
3839 | keywords = {M680XX, Motorola}, |
---|
3840 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3841 | key = {Motorola}, |
---|
3842 | title = {M68000 Family Programmer's Reference Manual}, |
---|
3843 | publisher = {Motorola}, |
---|
3844 | year = 1992, |
---|
3845 | } |
---|
3846 | |
---|
3847 | @article{c++libs, |
---|
3848 | keywords = {directory structure}, |
---|
3849 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3850 | author = {J. M. Coggins and G. Bollella}, |
---|
3851 | title = {Managing {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Libraries}, |
---|
3852 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
3853 | year = 1989, |
---|
3854 | month = jun, volume = 24, number = 6, pages = {37-48}, |
---|
3855 | abstract = { |
---|
3856 | This paper describes a scheme we have used to manage a large |
---|
3857 | library written in the C++ language. The scheme imposes a |
---|
3858 | directory structure, and represents dependency hierarchy in a |
---|
3859 | globally accessible file we call the 'prelude' file. We also |
---|
3860 | discuss the structure of the description files (makefiles) used |
---|
3861 | with the UNIX options we have found to be useful in reducing the |
---|
3862 | size of the library, and how to minimize recompilation time after |
---|
3863 | trivial changes to the source code of the library. |
---|
3864 | } |
---|
3865 | } |
---|
3866 | |
---|
3867 | @inproceedings{mprof, |
---|
3868 | keywords = {malloc}, |
---|
3869 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
3870 | author = {Benjamin Zorn and Paul Hilfinger}, |
---|
3871 | title = {A Memory Allocation Profiler for {C} and Lisp Programs}, |
---|
3872 | booktitle = {Summer 1988 {USENIX} proceedings}, |
---|
3873 | year = 1988 |
---|
3874 | } |
---|
3875 | |
---|
3876 | @manual{MMTk, |
---|
3877 | keywords = {Java memory management}, |
---|
3878 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3879 | title = {MMTk: The Memory Management Toolkit}, |
---|
3880 | author = {Steve Blackburn and Robin Garner and Daniel Frampton}, |
---|
3881 | month = sep, |
---|
3882 | year = 2006, |
---|
3883 | note = {\textsf{http://cs.anu.edu.au/\-\char`\~Robin.Garner/\-mmtk-guide.pdf}}, |
---|
3884 | } |
---|
3885 | |
---|
3886 | @article{Adve10, |
---|
3887 | keywords = {Java memory management}, |
---|
3888 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3889 | author = {Sarita V. Adve and Hans-J. Boehm}, |
---|
3890 | title = {Memory Models: A Case for Rethinking Parallel Languages and Hardware}, |
---|
3891 | journal = cacm, |
---|
3892 | volume = 53, |
---|
3893 | number = 8, |
---|
3894 | month = aug, |
---|
3895 | year = 2010, |
---|
3896 | pages = {90-101}, |
---|
3897 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
3898 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
3899 | } |
---|
3900 | @techreport{Mesa, |
---|
3901 | keywords = {monitors, packages}, |
---|
3902 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3903 | author = {James G. Mitchell and William Maybury and Richard Sweet}, |
---|
3904 | title = {Mesa Language Manual}, |
---|
3905 | institution = {Xerox Palo Alto Research Center}, |
---|
3906 | number = {CSL--79--3}, |
---|
3907 | month = apr, |
---|
3908 | year = 1979 |
---|
3909 | } |
---|
3910 | |
---|
3911 | @article{Andrews89, |
---|
3912 | keywords = {semaphore, split-binary, baton}, |
---|
3913 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3914 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews}, |
---|
3915 | title = {A Method for Solving Synronization Problems}, |
---|
3916 | journal = scp, |
---|
3917 | volume = 13, |
---|
3918 | number = 4, |
---|
3919 | month = dec, |
---|
3920 | year = 1989, |
---|
3921 | pages = {1-21}, |
---|
3922 | } |
---|
3923 | |
---|
3924 | @inproceedings{Mitchell78, |
---|
3925 | keywords = {Mesa}, |
---|
3926 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3927 | author = {James G. Mitchell}, |
---|
3928 | title = {Mesa: A Designer's User Perspective}, |
---|
3929 | booktitle = {Spring CompCom 78}, |
---|
3930 | organization= {Sixteenth IEEE Computer Society International Conference}, |
---|
3931 | address = {San Francisco, California, U.S.A.}, |
---|
3932 | month = feb, |
---|
3933 | year = 1978, |
---|
3934 | pages = {36-39}, |
---|
3935 | note = {IEEE Catalog No. 78CH1328-4C}, |
---|
3936 | } |
---|
3937 | |
---|
3938 | @article{Gentleman81, |
---|
3939 | keywords = {messages, concurrency}, |
---|
3940 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3941 | author = {W. Morven Gentleman}, |
---|
3942 | title = {Message Passing between Sequential Processes: |
---|
3943 | the Reply Primitive and the Administrator Concept}, |
---|
3944 | journal = spe, |
---|
3945 | month = may, |
---|
3946 | year = 1981, |
---|
3947 | volume = 11, |
---|
3948 | number = 5, |
---|
3949 | pages = {435-466} |
---|
3950 | } |
---|
3951 | |
---|
3952 | @article{Cormack88, |
---|
3953 | keywords = {concurrency}, |
---|
3954 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3955 | author = {G. V. Cormack}, |
---|
3956 | title = {A Micro Kernel for Concurrency in C}, |
---|
3957 | journal = spe, |
---|
3958 | month = may, |
---|
3959 | year = 1988, |
---|
3960 | volume = 18, |
---|
3961 | number = 4, |
---|
3962 | pages = {485-491} |
---|
3963 | } |
---|
3964 | |
---|
3965 | @article{Buhr90a, |
---|
3966 | keywords = {concurrency, light-weight process, shared memory}, |
---|
3967 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3968 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Richard A. Stroobosscher}, |
---|
3969 | title = {The $\mu${S}ystem: Providing Light-Weight Concurrency on Shared-Memory Multiprocessor Computers Running {UNIX}}, |
---|
3970 | journal = spe, |
---|
3971 | volume = 20, |
---|
3972 | number = 9, |
---|
3973 | month = sep, |
---|
3974 | year = 1990, |
---|
3975 | pages = {929-963}, |
---|
3976 | } |
---|
3977 | |
---|
3978 | @techreport{uSystem, |
---|
3979 | keywords = {C, concurrency, light-weight process, shared memory}, |
---|
3980 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
3981 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Hamish I. Macdonald and Richard A. Stroobosscher}, |
---|
3982 | title = {$\mu${S}ystem Annotated Reference Manual, Version 4.4.3}, |
---|
3983 | institution = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo}, |
---|
3984 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
3985 | month = sep, |
---|
3986 | year = 1994, |
---|
3987 | note = {{\small\textsf{ftp://\-plg.uwaterloo.ca/\-pub/\-uSystem/\-uSystem.ps.gz}}}, |
---|
3988 | } |
---|
3989 | |
---|
3990 | @book{Mips4000, |
---|
3991 | key = {Mips4000}, |
---|
3992 | title = {MIPS R4000 Microprocessor User's Manual}, |
---|
3993 | publisher = {MIPS Computer Systems Inc}, |
---|
3994 | year = 1991, |
---|
3995 | } |
---|
3996 | |
---|
3997 | @inproceedings{Mjolner, |
---|
3998 | keywords = {Mjolner, hierarchical windows}, |
---|
3999 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4000 | author = {G\"{o}rel Hedin and Boris Magnusson}, |
---|
4001 | title = {The Mj{\o}lner Environment: Direct Interaction with Abstractions}, |
---|
4002 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the European Conference on Object Oriented Programming}, |
---|
4003 | organization= {ECOOP'88}, |
---|
4004 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
4005 | volume = 322, |
---|
4006 | editor = {S. Gjessing and K. Nygaard}, |
---|
4007 | address = {Oslo, Norway}, |
---|
4008 | month = aug, |
---|
4009 | year = 1988, |
---|
4010 | pages = {41-54}, |
---|
4011 | note = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science, Ed. by G. Goos and J. Hartmanis}, |
---|
4012 | } |
---|
4013 | |
---|
4014 | @article{Skillicorn98, |
---|
4015 | keywords = {parallel models}, |
---|
4016 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4017 | author = {David B. Skillicorn and Domenico Talia}, |
---|
4018 | title = {Models and Languages for Parallel Computation}, |
---|
4019 | journal = acmcs, |
---|
4020 | volume = 30, |
---|
4021 | number = 2, |
---|
4022 | month = jun, |
---|
4023 | year = 1998, |
---|
4024 | pages = {123-169}, |
---|
4025 | } |
---|
4026 | |
---|
4027 | @article{Werther96, |
---|
4028 | keywords = {C++, language syntax}, |
---|
4029 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4030 | author = {Ben Werther and Damian Conway}, |
---|
4031 | title = {A Modest Proposal: {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Resyntaxed}, |
---|
4032 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
4033 | volume = 31, |
---|
4034 | number = 11, |
---|
4035 | month = nov, |
---|
4036 | year = 1996, |
---|
4037 | pages = {74-82}, |
---|
4038 | } |
---|
4039 | |
---|
4040 | @book{Alexandrescu01, |
---|
4041 | keywords = {c design-patterns programming}, |
---|
4042 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4043 | author = {Andrei Alexandrescu}, |
---|
4044 | title = {Modern C++ Design: Generic Programming and Design Patterns Applied}, |
---|
4045 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley Professional}, |
---|
4046 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
4047 | month = feb, |
---|
4048 | year = 2001, |
---|
4049 | isbn = {0201704315}, |
---|
4050 | } |
---|
4051 | |
---|
4052 | @book{Tanenbaum92, |
---|
4053 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems}, |
---|
4054 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4055 | author = {Andrew S. Tanenbaum}, |
---|
4056 | title = {Modern Operating Systems}, |
---|
4057 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
4058 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
4059 | year = 1992, |
---|
4060 | } |
---|
4061 | |
---|
4062 | @article{Wirth77, |
---|
4063 | keywords = {modules, coroutines}, |
---|
4064 | contributer = {pabuhr}, |
---|
4065 | author = {Niklaus Wirth}, |
---|
4066 | title = {Modula: a Language for Modular Multiprogramming}, |
---|
4067 | journal = spe, |
---|
4068 | month = {January--February}, |
---|
4069 | year = 1977, |
---|
4070 | volume = 7, |
---|
4071 | number = 1, |
---|
4072 | pages = {3-35}, |
---|
4073 | } |
---|
4074 | |
---|
4075 | @book{Harbison92, |
---|
4076 | contributer = {mhcoffin}, |
---|
4077 | author = {Samuel P. Harbison}, |
---|
4078 | title = {Modula-3}, |
---|
4079 | publisher = {Prentise Hall, Inc.}, |
---|
4080 | year = {1992}, |
---|
4081 | comment = {This is a textbook for learning Modula-3.} |
---|
4082 | } |
---|
4083 | |
---|
4084 | @techreport{Modula-3:old, |
---|
4085 | keywords = {Modula-3, inheritance, type extension}, |
---|
4086 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4087 | author = {Luca Cardelli and James Donahue and Lucille Glassman and Mick |
---|
4088 | Jordan and Bill Kalsow and Greg Nelson}, |
---|
4089 | title = {Modula-3 Report}, |
---|
4090 | institution = {Systems Research Center}, |
---|
4091 | address = {130 Lytton Avenue, Palo Alto, California 94301}, |
---|
4092 | month = aug, |
---|
4093 | year = 1988, |
---|
4094 | number = 31 |
---|
4095 | } |
---|
4096 | |
---|
4097 | @article{Dueck90, |
---|
4098 | keywords = {attribute grammars}, |
---|
4099 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4100 | author = {Gerald D. P. Dueck and Gordon V. Cormack}, |
---|
4101 | title = {Modular Attribute Grammars}, |
---|
4102 | journal = {The Computer Journal}, |
---|
4103 | month = apr, |
---|
4104 | year = 1990, |
---|
4105 | volume = 33, |
---|
4106 | number = 2, |
---|
4107 | pages = {164-172}, |
---|
4108 | } |
---|
4109 | |
---|
4110 | @article{Yemini85, |
---|
4111 | keywords = {exception handling}, |
---|
4112 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4113 | author = {Shaula Yemini and Daniel M. Berry}, |
---|
4114 | title = {A Modular Verifiable Exception-Handling Mechanism}, |
---|
4115 | journal = toplas, |
---|
4116 | month = apr, |
---|
4117 | year = 1985, |
---|
4118 | volume = 7, |
---|
4119 | number = 2, |
---|
4120 | pages = {214-243}, |
---|
4121 | } |
---|
4122 | |
---|
4123 | @article{Buhr95b, |
---|
4124 | keywords = {concurrency, monitors, classification}, |
---|
4125 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4126 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Michel Fortier and Michael H. Coffin}, |
---|
4127 | title = {Monitor Classification}, |
---|
4128 | journal = acmcs, |
---|
4129 | volume = 27, |
---|
4130 | number = 1, |
---|
4131 | month = mar, |
---|
4132 | year = 1995, |
---|
4133 | pages = {63-107}, |
---|
4134 | } |
---|
4135 | |
---|
4136 | @article{Hoare74, |
---|
4137 | keywords = {monitor}, |
---|
4138 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4139 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare}, |
---|
4140 | title = {Monitors: An Operating System Structuring Concept}, |
---|
4141 | journal = cacm, |
---|
4142 | volume = 17, |
---|
4143 | number = 10, |
---|
4144 | month = oct, |
---|
4145 | year = 1974, |
---|
4146 | pages = {549-557}, |
---|
4147 | annote = { |
---|
4148 | } |
---|
4149 | } |
---|
4150 | |
---|
4151 | @inbook{Buhr99a, |
---|
4152 | keywords = {concurrency, monitors, classification}, |
---|
4153 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4154 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Michel Fortier and Michael H. Coffin}, |
---|
4155 | title = {Encyclopedia of Computer Science and Technology}, |
---|
4156 | chapter = {Monitor Taxonomy}, |
---|
4157 | publisher = {Marcel Dekker, Inc}, |
---|
4158 | volume = {40, supplement 25}, |
---|
4159 | year = 1999, |
---|
4160 | pages = {191-212}, |
---|
4161 | } |
---|
4162 | % editor = {Allen Kent and James G. Williams}, |
---|
4163 | |
---|
4164 | @manual{MPI, |
---|
4165 | keywords = {MPI}, |
---|
4166 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4167 | title = {MPI: A Message-Passing Interface Standard, Version 3.1}, |
---|
4168 | organization= {Message Passing Interface Forum}, |
---|
4169 | address = {University of Tennessee, Knoxville, Tennessee}, |
---|
4170 | month = jun, |
---|
4171 | year = 2015, |
---|
4172 | note = {\href{http://www.mpi-forum.org/docs/mpi-3.1/mpi31-report.pdf}{\textsf{http://www.mpi-forum.org/\-docs/\-mpi-3.1/\-mpi31-report.pdf}}}, |
---|
4173 | } |
---|
4174 | |
---|
4175 | @article{multilisp, |
---|
4176 | keywords = {futures, scheme}, |
---|
4177 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4178 | author = {Halstead, Jr.,Robert H.}, |
---|
4179 | title = {Multilisp: A Language for Concurrent Symbolic Programming}, |
---|
4180 | journal = toplas, |
---|
4181 | volume = 7, |
---|
4182 | number = 4, |
---|
4183 | pages = {501-538}, |
---|
4184 | month = oct, |
---|
4185 | year = 1985, |
---|
4186 | comment = { |
---|
4187 | (future E) begins evaluating the expression E, and |
---|
4188 | returns a ``future'' representing the value. When evaluation is |
---|
4189 | finished, the value of E replaces the future. Operations that need |
---|
4190 | the future's value suspend until it is available. Assignment and |
---|
4191 | parameter passing do not suspend. Future introduces concurrency |
---|
4192 | between the calculation of a value and its use; reference to |
---|
4193 | futures is a synchronization mechanism. |
---|
4194 | |
---|
4195 | (pcall F A B ... C) concurrently evaluates F, A, B, ... C, and then |
---|
4196 | applies F to the arguments. pcall can be built from future and a |
---|
4197 | ``touch'' operation. pcall is included because it may not be easy |
---|
4198 | to determine that there are no critical sections between the future |
---|
4199 | expression and the code between the future call and the value's |
---|
4200 | first use. |
---|
4201 | |
---|
4202 | (delay E) is like future, but E's process does not begin until its |
---|
4203 | value is needed. It provides lazy evaluation. Replacing delay |
---|
4204 | with future would launch an infinite number of processes. |
---|
4205 | } |
---|
4206 | } |
---|
4207 | |
---|
4208 | @techreport{Bretthauer89, |
---|
4209 | keywords = {multiple inheritance}, |
---|
4210 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4211 | author = {Harry Bretthauer and Thomas Christaller and J\"{u}rgen Kopp}, |
---|
4212 | title = {Multiple vs. Single Inheritance in Object-oriented Programming Languages. What do we really want?}, |
---|
4213 | institution = {Gesellschaft F\"{u}r Mathematik und Datenverarbeitung mbH}, |
---|
4214 | address = {Schlo$\beta$ Birlinghoven, Postfach 12 40, D-5205 Sankt Augustin 1, Deutschland}, |
---|
4215 | number = {Arbeitspapiere der GMD 415}, |
---|
4216 | month = nov, |
---|
4217 | year = 1989, |
---|
4218 | } |
---|
4219 | |
---|
4220 | @inproceedings{c++:multinh, |
---|
4221 | keywords = {C++, multiple inheritance, implementation}, |
---|
4222 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4223 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
4224 | title = {Multiple Inheritance for {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
4225 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Spring '87 EUUG Conference}, |
---|
4226 | month = may, year = 1987 |
---|
4227 | } |
---|
4228 | |
---|
4229 | @inproceedings{st:mult, |
---|
4230 | keywords = {smalltalk, multiple inheritance, implementation}, |
---|
4231 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4232 | author = {Daniel H. H. Ingalls and A. H. Borning}, |
---|
4233 | title = {Multiple Inheritance in Smalltalk-80}, |
---|
4234 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the National Conference on Artificial Intelligence}, |
---|
4235 | month = aug, |
---|
4236 | year = 1982, |
---|
4237 | pages = {234-238}, |
---|
4238 | organization= {American Association for Artificial Intelligence}, |
---|
4239 | comment = { |
---|
4240 | Methods are looked up in the current class, the superclasses, the |
---|
4241 | supersuperclasses, etc. The same method can be inherited |
---|
4242 | repeatedly, but having different methods for the same message is an |
---|
4243 | error. Only one copy is made for multiply-inherited fields. |
---|
4244 | |
---|
4245 | {\tt X.m} is the method m in superclass X. {\tt super.m} is |
---|
4246 | allowed if there is no ambiguity; {\tt self super.m} replaces {\tt |
---|
4247 | super m}. {\tt all.m} invokes all inherited versions of m. |
---|
4248 | |
---|
4249 | Methods on the first-superclass chain are found as usual. Methods |
---|
4250 | from other superclasses are copied into the class dictionary. An |
---|
4251 | error method is created if inherited methods conflict. The parser |
---|
4252 | is changed to allow compound selectors. {\tt Object |
---|
4253 | messageNotUnderstood} is changed to look for compound selectors and |
---|
4254 | dynamically add a method with the right name and body to the class. |
---|
4255 | When methods are edited, they are copied into subclasses and |
---|
4256 | compound selector versions are deleted, as appropriate. |
---|
4257 | } |
---|
4258 | } |
---|
4259 | |
---|
4260 | @article{Lamport86I, |
---|
4261 | keywords = {software solutions, N-thread, mutual exclusions}, |
---|
4262 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4263 | author = {Leslie Lamport}, |
---|
4264 | title = {The Mutual Exclusion Problem: Part\,{I}--A Theory of Interprocess Communication}, |
---|
4265 | journal = jacm, |
---|
4266 | volume = 33, |
---|
4267 | number = 2, |
---|
4268 | month = apr, |
---|
4269 | year = 1986, |
---|
4270 | pages = {313--326}, |
---|
4271 | numpages = {14}, |
---|
4272 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
4273 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
4274 | } |
---|
4275 | |
---|
4276 | @article{Lamport86II, |
---|
4277 | keywords = {software solutions, N-thread, mutual exclusions}, |
---|
4278 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4279 | author = {Leslie Lamport}, |
---|
4280 | title = {The Mutual Exclusion Problem: Part\,{II}--Statement and Solutions}, |
---|
4281 | journal = jacm, |
---|
4282 | volume = 33, |
---|
4283 | number = 2, |
---|
4284 | month = apr, |
---|
4285 | year = 1986, |
---|
4286 | pages = {327--348}, |
---|
4287 | numpages = {22}, |
---|
4288 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
4289 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
4290 | } |
---|
4291 | |
---|
4292 | @article{Burns78, |
---|
4293 | keywords = {hardware, N-process solution, O(N)}, |
---|
4294 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4295 | author = {James E. Burns}, |
---|
4296 | title = {Mutual Exclusion with Linear Waiting Using Binary Shared Variables}, |
---|
4297 | journal = {SIGACT News}, |
---|
4298 | volume = 10, |
---|
4299 | number = 2, |
---|
4300 | month = {Summer}, |
---|
4301 | year = 1978, |
---|
4302 | pages = {42-47}, |
---|
4303 | } |
---|
4304 | |
---|
4305 | @inproceedings{Burns80, |
---|
4306 | keywords = {N-process software solution}, |
---|
4307 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4308 | author = {James E. Burns and Nancy A. Lynch}, |
---|
4309 | title = {Mutual Exclusion using Indivisible Reads and Writes}, |
---|
4310 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 18th Annual Allerton Conference on Communications, Control and Computing, Monticello, Illinois, USA}, |
---|
4311 | year = 1980, |
---|
4312 | pages = {833-842}, |
---|
4313 | note = {\href{http://groups.csail.mit.edu/tds/papers/Lynch/allertonconf.pdf}{\textsf{http://\-groups.csail.mit.edu/\-tds/\-papers/\-Lynch/\-allertonconf.pdf}} [Accessed on March 2014]}, |
---|
4314 | optnote = {\textsf{http://\-groups.csail.mit.edu/\-tds/\-papers/\-Lynch/\-allertonconf.pdf}}, |
---|
4315 | } |
---|
4316 | |
---|
4317 | @article{Peterson81, |
---|
4318 | keywords = {concurrency, critical section}, |
---|
4319 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4320 | author = {G. L. Peterson}, |
---|
4321 | title = {Myths About the Mutual Exclusion Problem}, |
---|
4322 | journal = ipl, |
---|
4323 | year = 1981, |
---|
4324 | month = jun, |
---|
4325 | volume = 12, |
---|
4326 | number = 3, |
---|
4327 | pages = {115-116}, |
---|
4328 | } |
---|
4329 | |
---|
4330 | % N |
---|
4331 | |
---|
4332 | @article{Haddon77, |
---|
4333 | keywords = {monitors, nested monitor calls}, |
---|
4334 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4335 | author = {Bruce K. Haddon}, |
---|
4336 | title = {Nested Monitor Calls}, |
---|
4337 | journal = osr, |
---|
4338 | volume = 11, |
---|
4339 | number = 4, |
---|
4340 | month = oct, |
---|
4341 | year = 1977, |
---|
4342 | pages = {18-23}, |
---|
4343 | } |
---|
4344 | |
---|
4345 | @inproceedings{nesting, |
---|
4346 | keywords = {}, |
---|
4347 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4348 | author = {Lori A. Clarke and Jack C. Wilenden and Alexander L. Wolf}, |
---|
4349 | title = {Nesting in {Ada} Programs is for the Birds}, |
---|
4350 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the ACM-SIGPLAN Symposium on the {Ada} |
---|
4351 | Programming Language}, |
---|
4352 | year = 1980, |
---|
4353 | month = dec, pages = {139-145}, |
---|
4354 | note = {SIGPLAN Notices, v. 15, n. 11}, |
---|
4355 | abstract = { |
---|
4356 | Given a data abstraction construct like the Ada package and in the |
---|
4357 | light of current thoughts on programming methodology, we feel that |
---|
4358 | nesting is an anachronism. In this paper we propose a nest-free |
---|
4359 | program style for Ada that eschews nested program units and |
---|
4360 | declarations within blocks and instead heavily utilizes packages |
---|
4361 | and context specifications as mechanisms for controlling |
---|
4362 | visibility. We view this proposal as a first step toward the |
---|
4363 | development of programming methods that exploit the novel language |
---|
4364 | features available in Ada. Consideration of this proposal's |
---|
4365 | ramifications for data flow, control flow, and overall program |
---|
4366 | structure substantiates our contention that a tree structure is |
---|
4367 | seldom a natural representation of a program and that nesting |
---|
4368 | therefore generally interferes with program development and |
---|
4369 | readability. |
---|
4370 | } |
---|
4371 | } |
---|
4372 | |
---|
4373 | @inproceedings{Buhr88, |
---|
4374 | keywords = {nested classes, persistence}, |
---|
4375 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4376 | author = {P. A. Buhr and C. R. Zarnke}, |
---|
4377 | title = {Nesting in an Object Oriented Language is NOT for the Birds}, |
---|
4378 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the European Conference on Object Oriented Programming}, |
---|
4379 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
4380 | volume = 322, |
---|
4381 | editor = {S. Gjessing and K. Nygaard}, |
---|
4382 | address = {Oslo, Norway}, |
---|
4383 | month = aug, |
---|
4384 | year = 1988, |
---|
4385 | pages = {128-145}, |
---|
4386 | note = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science, Ed. by G. Goos and J. Hartmanis}, |
---|
4387 | } |
---|
4388 | |
---|
4389 | @inproceedings{Thompson90new, |
---|
4390 | keywords = {Plan 9}, |
---|
4391 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4392 | title = {A New C Compiler}, |
---|
4393 | author = {Ken Thompson}, |
---|
4394 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Summer 1990 UKUUG Conference}, |
---|
4395 | year = 1990, |
---|
4396 | pages = {41--51}, |
---|
4397 | url = {http://doc.cat-v.org/bell_labs/new_c_compilers/new_c_compiler.pdf} |
---|
4398 | } |
---|
4399 | |
---|
4400 | @article{Trono94, |
---|
4401 | author = {John A. Trono}, |
---|
4402 | title = {A New Exercise in Concurrency}, |
---|
4403 | journal = {SIGCSE Bulletin}, |
---|
4404 | volume = {26}, |
---|
4405 | number = {3}, |
---|
4406 | month = sep, |
---|
4407 | year = {1994}, |
---|
4408 | pages = {8-10}, |
---|
4409 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
4410 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
4411 | } |
---|
4412 | |
---|
4413 | @article{Lamport74, |
---|
4414 | keywords = {concurrency, N-Process solution, O(N)}, |
---|
4415 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4416 | author = {Leslie Lamport}, |
---|
4417 | title = {A New Solution of Dijkstra's Concurrent Programming Problem}, |
---|
4418 | journal = cacm, |
---|
4419 | month = aug, |
---|
4420 | year = 1974, |
---|
4421 | volume = 17, |
---|
4422 | number = 8, |
---|
4423 | pages = {453-455}, |
---|
4424 | } |
---|
4425 | |
---|
4426 | @article{landin, |
---|
4427 | keywords = {}, |
---|
4428 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4429 | author = {P. J. Landin}, |
---|
4430 | title = {The Next 700 Programing Languages}, |
---|
4431 | journal = cacm, |
---|
4432 | year = 1966, |
---|
4433 | volume = 9, |
---|
4434 | pages = {157-164}, |
---|
4435 | } |
---|
4436 | |
---|
4437 | @article{Herlihy05, |
---|
4438 | keywords = {Multiprocessors, concurrent data structures, dynamic data structures, memory management, nonblocking synchronization}, |
---|
4439 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4440 | author = {Maurice Herlihy and Victor Luchangco and Paul Martin and Mark Moir}, |
---|
4441 | title = {Nonblocking Memory Management Support for Dynamic-sized Data Structures}, |
---|
4442 | journal = tocs, |
---|
4443 | volume = 23, |
---|
4444 | number = 2, |
---|
4445 | month = may, |
---|
4446 | year = 2005, |
---|
4447 | pages = {146-196}, |
---|
4448 | numpages = {51}, |
---|
4449 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
4450 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
4451 | } |
---|
4452 | |
---|
4453 | % O |
---|
4454 | |
---|
4455 | @inproceedings{oop:abcl/1, |
---|
4456 | keywords = {concurrency, OOPL, futures}, |
---|
4457 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4458 | author = {Akinori Yonezawa and Jean-Pierre Briot and Etsuya Shibayama}, |
---|
4459 | title = {Object-Oriented Concurrent Programming in {ABCL/1}}, |
---|
4460 | crossref = "OOPSLA86", |
---|
4461 | pages = {258-268}, |
---|
4462 | comment = { |
---|
4463 | Actions for messages sent to an object are executed concurrently |
---|
4464 | iff the object has no members. A select construct specifies a set |
---|
4465 | of message patterns. |
---|
4466 | |
---|
4467 | Express messages have priority. If an express message arrives |
---|
4468 | while an ordinary message is being processed, the action for the |
---|
4469 | ordinary message is suspended or aborted and the action for the |
---|
4470 | express message is executed. The sender decides which class a |
---|
4471 | message belongs in. Non-interruptible sections can be defined. |
---|
4472 | |
---|
4473 | Message sends can be non-blocking, or can block until a reply is |
---|
4474 | received, at the sender's option. The receiver can continue to |
---|
4475 | execute after sending the reply. |
---|
4476 | |
---|
4477 | Replies can send back ``futures'', and put values in them later. |
---|
4478 | Futures are queues of values, not single values. The caller can |
---|
4479 | use a ``ready?'' predicate to test for empty queue, or can use |
---|
4480 | operations to get the first or all queue elements; these operations |
---|
4481 | block if the queue is empty. |
---|
4482 | } |
---|
4483 | } |
---|
4484 | |
---|
4485 | @techreport{Schmidt95, |
---|
4486 | keywords = {ACE, concurrency, library}, |
---|
4487 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4488 | author = {Douglas C. Schmidt}, |
---|
4489 | title = {An OO Encapsulation of Lightweight OS Concurrency Mechanisms in the {ACE} Toolkit}, |
---|
4490 | institution = {Washington University in St. Louis}, |
---|
4491 | year = 1995, |
---|
4492 | number = 31, |
---|
4493 | note = {{\small\textsf{http://\-www.cs.wustl.edu/\-\char`\~schmidt/\-PDF/\-IPC\_SAP-92.pdf}}}, |
---|
4494 | } |
---|
4495 | |
---|
4496 | @inproceedings{OOEx, |
---|
4497 | keywords = {Exceptions, object-oriented programming languages}, |
---|
4498 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4499 | author = {Christophe Dony}, |
---|
4500 | title = {An Object-oriented Exception Handling System for an Object-oriented Language}, |
---|
4501 | booktitle = {ECOOP '88. European Conference on Object-Oriented Programming}, |
---|
4502 | year = 1988, |
---|
4503 | pages = {146-161}, |
---|
4504 | editor = {S. Gjessing and K. Nygaard}, |
---|
4505 | organization= {DND, The Norwegian Computer Society}, |
---|
4506 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
4507 | comment = { |
---|
4508 | Objectives: |
---|
4509 | - Users can define new exceptions. |
---|
4510 | - Default handlers can be attached to exceptions. |
---|
4511 | - Handlers can be attached to classes. |
---|
4512 | - Handlers can be attached to dynamic entities (expressions). |
---|
4513 | - Exceptions propagate first along the invocation chain. |
---|
4514 | - Exceptions should be hierarchically organized classes. |
---|
4515 | - Handlers should take into account the exception hierarchy (i.e., |
---|
4516 | should handle raising of sub-exceptions). |
---|
4517 | The ``exceptional-event'' class has two subclasses. ``Warning'' |
---|
4518 | has a ``resume'' method, and ``error'' has ``exit'' and |
---|
4519 | ``retry'' methods. Signalling an exception creates an instance |
---|
4520 | of the exception, whose members are used to pass information |
---|
4521 | back to the handler. Handlers are instances of class |
---|
4522 | ``protect-handler'' with a method ``protect {\em expression}'', |
---|
4523 | or are methods defined for the class or the exception. |
---|
4524 | } |
---|
4525 | } |
---|
4526 | |
---|
4527 | @article{CommonObjects, |
---|
4528 | author = {A. Snyder}, |
---|
4529 | title = {Object-Oriented Programming for Common Lisp}, |
---|
4530 | address = {Palo Alto CA}, |
---|
4531 | year = 1985, |
---|
4532 | publisher = {Software Technology Laboratory, Hewlett-Packard Laboratories}, |
---|
4533 | journal = {Report ATC-85-1}, |
---|
4534 | } |
---|
4535 | |
---|
4536 | @book{objective-c, |
---|
4537 | keywords = {}, |
---|
4538 | author = {Brad J. Cox}, |
---|
4539 | title = {Object-oriented programming; an evolutionary approach}, |
---|
4540 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
4541 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
4542 | year = 1986 |
---|
4543 | } |
---|
4544 | |
---|
4545 | @book{Beta, |
---|
4546 | keywords = {Beta, object oriented, concurrency, exceptions}, |
---|
4547 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4548 | author = {Ole Lehrmann Madsen and Birger M{\o}ller-Pedersen and Kristen Nygaard}, |
---|
4549 | title = {Object-oriented Programming in the {BETA} Programming Language}, |
---|
4550 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
4551 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
4552 | year = 1993, |
---|
4553 | } |
---|
4554 | |
---|
4555 | @article{Flavors, |
---|
4556 | author = {D. A. Moon}, |
---|
4557 | title = {Object-Oriented Programming with Flavors}, |
---|
4558 | address = {Portland OR}, |
---|
4559 | month = sep, |
---|
4560 | year = 1986, |
---|
4561 | journal = {Proc. ACM Conf. on Object-Oriented Systems, Languages and Applications}, |
---|
4562 | } |
---|
4563 | |
---|
4564 | @article{Buhr00b, |
---|
4565 | keywords = {concurrency, C++, real-time}, |
---|
4566 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4567 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Ashif S. Harji and Philipp E. Lim and Jiongxiong Chen}, |
---|
4568 | title = {Object-Oriented Real-Time Concurrency}, |
---|
4569 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
4570 | volume = 35, |
---|
4571 | number = 10, |
---|
4572 | month = oct, |
---|
4573 | year = 2000, |
---|
4574 | pages = {29-46}, |
---|
4575 | note = {OOPSLA'00, Oct. 15--19, 2000, Minneapolis, Minnesota, U.S.A.}, |
---|
4576 | } |
---|
4577 | |
---|
4578 | @book{Meyer88, |
---|
4579 | keywords = {Eiffel}, |
---|
4580 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4581 | author = {Bertrand Meyer}, |
---|
4582 | title = {Object-oriented Software Construction}, |
---|
4583 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
4584 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
4585 | year = {1988}, |
---|
4586 | series = {Prentice-Hall International Series in Computer Science}, |
---|
4587 | } |
---|
4588 | |
---|
4589 | @article{objectPascal, |
---|
4590 | keywords = {objects, modules}, |
---|
4591 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4592 | author = {Larry Tesler}, |
---|
4593 | title = {Object Pascal Report}, |
---|
4594 | journal = {Structured Language World}, |
---|
4595 | year = 1985, |
---|
4596 | volume = 9, |
---|
4597 | number = 3, |
---|
4598 | } |
---|
4599 | |
---|
4600 | @misc{obj-c:next, |
---|
4601 | keywords = {categories, protocols, Objective C}, |
---|
4602 | contributor = {gjditchfield@angus}, |
---|
4603 | author = {NeXT Computer, Inc.}, |
---|
4604 | title = {Objective C Extensions}, |
---|
4605 | howpublished= {On-line documentation in ``NEXTSTEP 3.1 Developer''}, |
---|
4606 | year = 1993 |
---|
4607 | } |
---|
4608 | |
---|
4609 | @book{Galletly96, |
---|
4610 | keywords = {occam}, |
---|
4611 | author = {John Galletly}, |
---|
4612 | title = {{OCCAM} 2: Including {OCCAM} 2.1}, |
---|
4613 | publisher = {{UCL} (University College London) Press}, |
---|
4614 | address = {London}, |
---|
4615 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
4616 | year = 1996, |
---|
4617 | } |
---|
4618 | |
---|
4619 | @techreport{Morrison88, |
---|
4620 | keywords = {objects, concurrency, persistence}, |
---|
4621 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4622 | author = {R. Morrison and A. L. Brown and R. Carrick and R. Connor and A. Dearle}, |
---|
4623 | title = {On the integration of Object-Oriented and Process-Oriented computation in persistent environments}, |
---|
4624 | institution = {Department of Computational Science, University of St. Andrews, Scotland}, |
---|
4625 | number = {PPRR 57}, |
---|
4626 | month = jan, |
---|
4627 | year = 1988, |
---|
4628 | } |
---|
4629 | |
---|
4630 | @article{Peterson73, |
---|
4631 | keywords = {goto, structured programming}, |
---|
4632 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4633 | author = {W. W. Peterson and T. Kasami and N. Tokura}, |
---|
4634 | title = {On the Capabilities of While, Repeat, and Exit Statements}, |
---|
4635 | journal = cacm, |
---|
4636 | month = aug, |
---|
4637 | year = 1973, |
---|
4638 | volume = 16, |
---|
4639 | number = 8, |
---|
4640 | pages = {503-512} |
---|
4641 | } |
---|
4642 | |
---|
4643 | @article{Baker82, |
---|
4644 | keywords = {compilation}, |
---|
4645 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4646 | author = {Theodore P. Baker}, |
---|
4647 | title = {A One-Pass Algorithm for Overload Resolution in {Ada}}, |
---|
4648 | journal = toplas, |
---|
4649 | year = 1982, |
---|
4650 | month = oct, |
---|
4651 | volume = 4, |
---|
4652 | number = 4, |
---|
4653 | pages = {601-614}, |
---|
4654 | abstract = { |
---|
4655 | A simple method is presented for detecting ambiguities and finding |
---|
4656 | the correct interpretations of expressions in the programming |
---|
4657 | language Ada. Unlike previously reported solutions to this |
---|
4658 | problem, which require multiple passes over a tree structure, the |
---|
4659 | method described here operates in one bottom-up pass, during which |
---|
4660 | a directed acyclic graph is produced. The correctness of this |
---|
4661 | approach is demonstrated by a brief formal argument. |
---|
4662 | }, |
---|
4663 | comment = { |
---|
4664 | See also \cite{D:overload}. |
---|
4665 | } |
---|
4666 | } |
---|
4667 | |
---|
4668 | @techreport{OpenMP, |
---|
4669 | keywords = {concurrency, openmp, spmd}, |
---|
4670 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4671 | author = {OpenMP Architecture Review Board}, |
---|
4672 | title = {OpenMP Application Program Interface, Version 4.0}, |
---|
4673 | month = jul, |
---|
4674 | year = 2013, |
---|
4675 | note = {\href{http://www.openmp.org/mp-documents/OpenMP4.0.0.pdf}{\textsf{http://\-www.openmp.org/\-mp-documents/\-OpenMP4.0.0.pdf}}}, |
---|
4676 | } |
---|
4677 | |
---|
4678 | @book{Deitel04, |
---|
4679 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems}, |
---|
4680 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4681 | author = {Harvey M. Deitel and Paul J. Deitel and David R. Choffnes}, |
---|
4682 | title = {Operating Systems}, |
---|
4683 | publisher = {Pearson Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
4684 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
4685 | year = 2004, |
---|
4686 | edition = {3rd}, |
---|
4687 | } |
---|
4688 | |
---|
4689 | @book{Stalling98, |
---|
4690 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems}, |
---|
4691 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4692 | author = {William Stallings}, |
---|
4693 | title = {Operating Systems: Internals and Design Principles}, |
---|
4694 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
4695 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
4696 | year = 1998, |
---|
4697 | edition = {3rd}, |
---|
4698 | } |
---|
4699 | |
---|
4700 | @book{Stalling01, |
---|
4701 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems}, |
---|
4702 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4703 | author = {William Stallings}, |
---|
4704 | title = {Operating Systems: Internals and Design Principles}, |
---|
4705 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
4706 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
4707 | year = 2001, |
---|
4708 | edition = {4th}, |
---|
4709 | } |
---|
4710 | |
---|
4711 | @book{Silberschatz91, |
---|
4712 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems}, |
---|
4713 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4714 | author = {Abraham Silberschatz and James L. Peterson and Peter Galvin}, |
---|
4715 | title = {Operating System Concepts}, |
---|
4716 | publisher = {Addision-Wesley}, |
---|
4717 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
4718 | year = 1991, |
---|
4719 | edition = {3rd}, |
---|
4720 | } |
---|
4721 | |
---|
4722 | @book{Tanenbaum87, |
---|
4723 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems}, |
---|
4724 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4725 | author = {Andrew S. Tanenbaum}, |
---|
4726 | title = {Operating Systems : Design and Implementation}, |
---|
4727 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
4728 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
4729 | series = {Software Series}, |
---|
4730 | year = 1987, |
---|
4731 | } |
---|
4732 | |
---|
4733 | @book{Hansen73, |
---|
4734 | keywords = {monitors}, |
---|
4735 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4736 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}}, |
---|
4737 | title = {Operating System Principles}, |
---|
4738 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
4739 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
4740 | year = 1973, |
---|
4741 | } |
---|
4742 | |
---|
4743 | @book{Bic03, |
---|
4744 | keywords = {concurrency, operating systems}, |
---|
4745 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4746 | author = {Lubomir F. Bic and Alan C. Shaw}, |
---|
4747 | title = {Operating System Principles}, |
---|
4748 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
4749 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
4750 | year = 2003, |
---|
4751 | } |
---|
4752 | |
---|
4753 | @techreport{milner88, |
---|
4754 | keywords = {}, |
---|
4755 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4756 | author = {Robin Milner}, |
---|
4757 | title = {Operational and Algebraic Semantics of Concurrent Processes}, |
---|
4758 | institution = {Laboratory for Foundations of Computer Science}, |
---|
4759 | year = 1988, |
---|
4760 | address = {Department of Computer Science, University of Edinburgh, Edinburgh EH9 3JZ}, |
---|
4761 | month = feb, |
---|
4762 | number = {ECS-LFCS-88-46} |
---|
4763 | } |
---|
4764 | |
---|
4765 | @article{Ganzinger80, |
---|
4766 | contributer = {a3moss@uwaterloo.ca}, |
---|
4767 | author = {Ganzinger, Harald and Ripken, Knut}, |
---|
4768 | title = {Operator Identification in {ADA}: Formal Specification, Complexity, and Concrete Implementation}, |
---|
4769 | journal = {SIGPLAN Notices}, |
---|
4770 | issue_date = {February 1980}, |
---|
4771 | volume = {15}, |
---|
4772 | number = {2}, |
---|
4773 | month = feb, |
---|
4774 | year = {1980}, |
---|
4775 | issn = {0362-1340}, |
---|
4776 | pages = {30--42}, |
---|
4777 | numpages = {13}, |
---|
4778 | url = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/947586.947589}, |
---|
4779 | doi = {10.1145/947586.947589}, |
---|
4780 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
4781 | address = {New York, NY, USA} |
---|
4782 | } |
---|
4783 | |
---|
4784 | @article{Ford82, |
---|
4785 | keywords = {}, |
---|
4786 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4787 | author = {G. Ford and B. Hansche}, |
---|
4788 | title = {Optional, Repeatable, and Varying Type Parameters}, |
---|
4789 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
4790 | volume = 17, |
---|
4791 | number = 2, |
---|
4792 | month = feb, |
---|
4793 | year = 1982, |
---|
4794 | pages = {41-48}, |
---|
4795 | } |
---|
4796 | |
---|
4797 | @manual{pli, |
---|
4798 | keywords = {PL/I}, |
---|
4799 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4800 | key = {IBM}, |
---|
4801 | title = {{OS} and {DOS} {PL/I} Reference Manual}, |
---|
4802 | organization= {International Business Machines}, |
---|
4803 | edition = {1st}, |
---|
4804 | month = sep, |
---|
4805 | year = 1981, |
---|
4806 | note = {Manual GC26-3977-0}, |
---|
4807 | } |
---|
4808 | |
---|
4809 | @techreport{D:overload, |
---|
4810 | keywords = {overload resolution, compilation}, |
---|
4811 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4812 | author = {M. Dausmann et. al.}, |
---|
4813 | title = {Overloading in {Ada}}, |
---|
4814 | institution = {Universitat Karlsruhe}, |
---|
4815 | year = 1979, |
---|
4816 | number = {23/79}, |
---|
4817 | comment = { |
---|
4818 | Probably the earliest description of the two-pass (bottom-up, |
---|
4819 | top-down) overload resolution algorithm. See also |
---|
4820 | \cite{PW:overload,WS:overload,PDM:overload,Cor:overload,Bak:overload}. |
---|
4821 | } |
---|
4822 | } |
---|
4823 | |
---|
4824 | @article{EB87, |
---|
4825 | keywords = {packages, private types, assignment, equality}, |
---|
4826 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4827 | author = {J. Dana Eckart and Richard J. LeBlanc}, |
---|
4828 | title = {Overloading in the {Ada} Language: Is it too restrictive?}, |
---|
4829 | journal = {Computer Languages}, |
---|
4830 | year = 1987, |
---|
4831 | volume = 12, number = {3/4}, pages = {163-172}, |
---|
4832 | abstract = { |
---|
4833 | Packages in the Ada language provide a mechanism for extending the |
---|
4834 | language through the development of additional data types. Such |
---|
4835 | types can be better integrated into the language using operator |
---|
4836 | overloading; however, key limitations prevent new types from being |
---|
4837 | transparently integrated into the language. Allowing function |
---|
4838 | names to overload private type names would give a cleaner and |
---|
4839 | clearer mechanism for building values of these types. Furthermore, |
---|
4840 | by allowing redefinitions of ``:='' and by making it easier to |
---|
4841 | overload ``='' for private types, Ada coud be transformed into a |
---|
4842 | more expressive language. |
---|
4843 | } |
---|
4844 | } |
---|
4845 | |
---|
4846 | @article{PW:overload, |
---|
4847 | keywords = {compilation}, |
---|
4848 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4849 | author = {Guido Persch and Georg Winterstein and Manfred Dausman and Sophia Drossopoulou}, |
---|
4850 | title = {Overloading in Preliminary {Ada}}, |
---|
4851 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
4852 | year = 1980, |
---|
4853 | month = nov, volume = 15, number = 11, pages = {47-56}, |
---|
4854 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM-SIGPLAN Symposium on the {Ada} Programming |
---|
4855 | Language}, |
---|
4856 | comment = { |
---|
4857 | The two-pass (bottom-up, then top-down) algorithm, with a proof |
---|
4858 | that two passes suffice. See also \cite{D:overload}. |
---|
4859 | } |
---|
4860 | } |
---|
4861 | |
---|
4862 | @article{SR, |
---|
4863 | keywords = {concurrency, messages, rendezvous}, |
---|
4864 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4865 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews and Ronald A. Olsson and Michael Coffin and |
---|
4866 | Irving Elshoff and Kelvin Nilsen and Titus Purdin and Gregg Townsend}, |
---|
4867 | title = {An Overview of the {SR} Language and Implementation}, |
---|
4868 | journal = toplas, |
---|
4869 | month = jan, |
---|
4870 | year = 1988, |
---|
4871 | volume = 10, |
---|
4872 | number = 1, |
---|
4873 | pages = {51-86}, |
---|
4874 | } |
---|
4875 | |
---|
4876 | % P |
---|
4877 | |
---|
4878 | @article{Andrews91, |
---|
4879 | keywords = {general concurrency}, |
---|
4880 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4881 | author = {Gregory R. Andrews}, |
---|
4882 | title = {Paradigms for Process Interaction in Distributed Programs}, |
---|
4883 | journal = acmcs, |
---|
4884 | volume = 23, |
---|
4885 | number = 1, |
---|
4886 | month = mar, |
---|
4887 | year = 1991, |
---|
4888 | pages = {49-90}, |
---|
4889 | } |
---|
4890 | |
---|
4891 | @book{PPC++, |
---|
4892 | keywords = {concurrency, parallel, distributed, C++}, |
---|
4893 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4894 | editor = {Gregory V. Wilson and Paul Lu}, |
---|
4895 | title = {Parallel Programming in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
4896 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
4897 | series = {Scientific and Engineering Computation Series}, |
---|
4898 | year = 1996, |
---|
4899 | pages = {1-42}, |
---|
4900 | } |
---|
4901 | |
---|
4902 | @incollection{Stroustrup96, |
---|
4903 | keywords = {concurrency, C++}, |
---|
4904 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4905 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
4906 | title = {A Perspective on Concurrency in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
4907 | editor = {Gregory V. Wilson and Paul Lu}, |
---|
4908 | booktitle = {Parallel Programming in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
4909 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
4910 | series = {Scientific and Engineering Computation Series}, |
---|
4911 | year = 1996, |
---|
4912 | pages = {xxvi-xxvii}, |
---|
4913 | } |
---|
4914 | |
---|
4915 | @incollection{Yang96b, |
---|
4916 | keywords = {concurrency, C++}, |
---|
4917 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4918 | author = {Shelby X. Yang and Dennis Gannon and Peter Beckman and Jacob Gotwals and Neelakantan Sundaresan}, |
---|
4919 | editor = {Gregory V. Wilson and Paul Lu}, |
---|
4920 | title = {p{C}++}, |
---|
4921 | booktitle = {Parallel Programming in {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
4922 | publisher = {MIT Press}, |
---|
4923 | address = {Cambridge}, |
---|
4924 | series = {Scientific and Engineering Computation Series}, |
---|
4925 | pages = {507-546}, |
---|
4926 | year = 1996, |
---|
4927 | } |
---|
4928 | |
---|
4929 | @article{goguen84, |
---|
4930 | keywords = {}, |
---|
4931 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4932 | author = {Goseph A. Goguen}, |
---|
4933 | title = {Parameterized Programming}, |
---|
4934 | journal = ieeese, |
---|
4935 | year = 1984, |
---|
4936 | month = sep, volume = "SE-10", number = 5, pages = {528-543}, |
---|
4937 | abstract = { |
---|
4938 | Parameterized programming is a powerful technique for the reliable |
---|
4939 | reuse of software. In this technique, modules are parameterized |
---|
4940 | over very general interfaces that describe what properties of an |
---|
4941 | environment are required for the module to work correctly. |
---|
4942 | Reusability is enhanced by the flexibility of the parameterization |
---|
4943 | mechanism proposed here. Reliability is further enhanced by |
---|
4944 | permitting interface requirements to include more than purely |
---|
4945 | syntactic information. This paper introduces three new ideas that |
---|
4946 | seem especially useful in supporting parameterized programming: 1) |
---|
4947 | {\em theories}, which declare global properties of program modules |
---|
4948 | and interfaces; 2) {\em views}, which connect theories with program |
---|
4949 | modules in an elegant way; and 3) {\em module expressions}, a kind |
---|
4950 | of general structured program transformation which produces new |
---|
4951 | modules by modifying and combining existing modules. Although |
---|
4952 | these ideas are illustrated with some simple examples in the OBJ |
---|
4953 | programming language, they should also be taken as proposals for an |
---|
4954 | Ada library system, for adding modules to Prolog, and as |
---|
4955 | considerations for future language design efforts. OBJ is an |
---|
4956 | ultra-high level programming language, based upon rewrite rules, |
---|
4957 | that incorporates these ideas, and many others from modern |
---|
4958 | programming methodology. |
---|
4959 | } |
---|
4960 | } |
---|
4961 | |
---|
4962 | @inproceedings{c++:templates, |
---|
4963 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
4964 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4965 | title = {Parameterized Types for {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
4966 | booktitle = {USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Conference}, |
---|
4967 | organization= {USENIX Association}, |
---|
4968 | year = 1988, pages = {1-18} |
---|
4969 | } |
---|
4970 | |
---|
4971 | @inproceedings{Boehm85, |
---|
4972 | keywords = {second-order unification}, |
---|
4973 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
4974 | author = {Hans-J. Boehm}, |
---|
4975 | title = {Partial Polymorphic Type Inference is Undecidable}, |
---|
4976 | booktitle = {26th Annual Symposium on Foundations of Computer Science}, |
---|
4977 | year = 1985, |
---|
4978 | pages = {339-345}, |
---|
4979 | organization= {IEEE Computer Society}, |
---|
4980 | publisher = {IEEE Computer Society Press}, |
---|
4981 | address = {1730 Massachusetts Avenue, N.W, Washington, D.C. 20036-1903}, |
---|
4982 | summary = { |
---|
4983 | Given a base typed lambda calculus with function types, type |
---|
4984 | abstractions, and a recursive expression \(\mbox{fix } x:t.e\), |
---|
4985 | then type inference for the partially typed language |
---|
4986 | \begin{eqnarray} |
---|
4987 | \lambda x:\tau.e &\Rightarrow& \lambda x.e \\ |
---|
4988 | \mbox{fix } x:\tau.e &\Rightarrow& \mbox{fix } x.e \\ |
---|
4989 | e \tau &\Rightarrow& e ? |
---|
4990 | \end{eqnarray} |
---|
4991 | is undecidable. |
---|
4992 | } |
---|
4993 | } |
---|
4994 | |
---|
4995 | @book{Pascal, |
---|
4996 | keywords = {Pascal}, |
---|
4997 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
4998 | author = {Kathleen Jensen and Niklaus Wirth}, |
---|
4999 | title = {{P}ascal User Manual and Report}, |
---|
5000 | publisher = {Springer--Verlag}, |
---|
5001 | year = 1985, |
---|
5002 | edition = {3rd}, |
---|
5003 | note = {Revised by Andrew B. Mickel and James F. Miner, ISO Pascal Standard} |
---|
5004 | } |
---|
5005 | |
---|
5006 | @book{Pascal:old, |
---|
5007 | keywords = {Pascal}, |
---|
5008 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5009 | author = {Kathleen Jensen and Niklaus Wirth}, |
---|
5010 | title = {{P}ascal User Manual and Report}, |
---|
5011 | publisher = {Springer--Verlag}, |
---|
5012 | year = 1975, |
---|
5013 | edition = {1st}, |
---|
5014 | } |
---|
5015 | |
---|
5016 | @article{Turba85, |
---|
5017 | keywords = {Pascal, exception handling, inheritance}, |
---|
5018 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5019 | author = {Thomas N. Turba}, |
---|
5020 | title = {The {P}ascal Exception Handling Proposal}, |
---|
5021 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5022 | volume = 20, |
---|
5023 | number = 8, |
---|
5024 | month = aug, |
---|
5025 | year = 1985, |
---|
5026 | pages = {93-98}, |
---|
5027 | } |
---|
5028 | |
---|
5029 | @manual{Pascal/VS, |
---|
5030 | keywords = {PL/I}, |
---|
5031 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5032 | key = {IBM}, |
---|
5033 | title = {{P}ascal/{VS} Language Reference Manual}, |
---|
5034 | organization= {International Business Machines}, |
---|
5035 | edition = {1st}, |
---|
5036 | year = 1981, |
---|
5037 | note = {Manual SH20-6168-1}, |
---|
5038 | } |
---|
5039 | |
---|
5040 | @article{Anderson90, |
---|
5041 | keywords = {spin locks, back off, performance}, |
---|
5042 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5043 | author = {Thomas E. Anderson}, |
---|
5044 | title = {The Performance of Spin Lock Alternatives for Shared-Memory Multiprocessors}, |
---|
5045 | journal = ieeepds, |
---|
5046 | month = jan, |
---|
5047 | year = 1990, |
---|
5048 | volume = 1, |
---|
5049 | number = 1, |
---|
5050 | pages = {6-16}, |
---|
5051 | } |
---|
5052 | |
---|
5053 | @article{poly, |
---|
5054 | keywords = {Poly, Standard ML, Russell, persistence}, |
---|
5055 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5056 | author = {David C. J. Matthews}, |
---|
5057 | title = {Poly Manual}, |
---|
5058 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5059 | month = sep, year = 1985, |
---|
5060 | volume = 20, number = 9, pages = {52-76} |
---|
5061 | } |
---|
5062 | |
---|
5063 | @techreport{Atkinson87b, |
---|
5064 | keywords = {naming, persistence}, |
---|
5065 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5066 | author = {M. P. Atkinson and R. Morrison}, |
---|
5067 | title = {Polymorphic Names and Iterations}, |
---|
5068 | institution = {Universities of Glasgow and St. Andrews, Scotland}, |
---|
5069 | number = {PPRR-53-87}, |
---|
5070 | month = nov, |
---|
5071 | year = 1987, |
---|
5072 | } |
---|
5073 | |
---|
5074 | @book{Harland, |
---|
5075 | keywords = {}, |
---|
5076 | author = {David M. Harland}, |
---|
5077 | title = {Polymorphic Programming Languages: Design and Implementation}, |
---|
5078 | publisher = {Ellis Horwood}, |
---|
5079 | year = 1984, |
---|
5080 | series = {Computers and their Applications}, |
---|
5081 | address = {Market Cross House, Cooper Street, Chichester, West Sussex, |
---|
5082 | PO19 1EB, England}, |
---|
5083 | summary = { |
---|
5084 | The principles of Procedural Abstraction, Data Type Completeness, |
---|
5085 | Declaration Correspondence, and Orthogonality are ruthlessly applied |
---|
5086 | to the design of a polymorphic language. |
---|
5087 | } |
---|
5088 | } |
---|
5089 | |
---|
5090 | @unpublished{poa, |
---|
5091 | keywords = {Force N, type inference, reusability, transcendance}, |
---|
5092 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5093 | author = {G. V. Cormack and A. K. Wright}, |
---|
5094 | title = {Polymorphism, Overloading, and Abstraction}, |
---|
5095 | note = {personal communication} |
---|
5096 | } |
---|
5097 | |
---|
5098 | @inproceedings{forceone:impl, |
---|
5099 | keywords = {Parametric polymorphism, ForceOne}, |
---|
5100 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5101 | author = {G. V. Cormack and A. K. Wright}, |
---|
5102 | title = {Polymorphism in the Compiled Language {ForceOne}}, |
---|
5103 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 20th Hawaii International Conference on Systems Sciences}, |
---|
5104 | month = jan, |
---|
5105 | year = 1987, |
---|
5106 | pages = {284-292}, |
---|
5107 | } |
---|
5108 | |
---|
5109 | @incollection{POOL-T, |
---|
5110 | keywords = {objects, concurrency}, |
---|
5111 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5112 | author = {Pierre America}, |
---|
5113 | title = {POOL-T: A Parallel Object-Oriented Language}, |
---|
5114 | booktitle = {Object-Oriented Concurrent Programming}, |
---|
5115 | publisher = {The MIT Press}, |
---|
5116 | year = 1987, |
---|
5117 | pages = {199-220}, |
---|
5118 | editor = {Akinori Yonezawa and Mario Tokoro} |
---|
5119 | } |
---|
5120 | |
---|
5121 | @article{Hardgrave76, |
---|
5122 | keywords = {positional, keyword, parameters, arguments}, |
---|
5123 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5124 | author = {W. T. Hardgrave}, |
---|
5125 | title = {Positional versus Keyword Parameter Communication in Programming Languages}, |
---|
5126 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5127 | volume = 11, |
---|
5128 | number = 5, |
---|
5129 | month = may, |
---|
5130 | year = 1976, |
---|
5131 | pages = {52-58}, |
---|
5132 | } |
---|
5133 | |
---|
5134 | @book{PowerPC, |
---|
5135 | key = {PowerPC processor}, |
---|
5136 | title = {Programming Environments Manual for 32-Bit Implementations of the PowerPC ArchitectureARM Architecture}, |
---|
5137 | publisher = {Freescale Semiconductor}, |
---|
5138 | volume = {MPCFPE32B}, |
---|
5139 | edition = {Rev. 3}, |
---|
5140 | month = 9, |
---|
5141 | year = 2005, |
---|
5142 | } |
---|
5143 | |
---|
5144 | @article{Ada:preliminary, |
---|
5145 | keywords = {Ada}, |
---|
5146 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5147 | author = {Jean D. Ichbiah and Bernd Krieg-Brueckner and Brian A. Wichmann |
---|
5148 | and Henry F. Ledgard and Jean-Claude Heliard and Jean-Raymond Abrial |
---|
5149 | and John G. P. Barnes and Olivier Roubine}, |
---|
5150 | title = {Preliminary {Ada} Reference Manual}, |
---|
5151 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5152 | volume = 14, |
---|
5153 | number = 6, |
---|
5154 | month = jun, |
---|
5155 | year = 1979, |
---|
5156 | note = {Part A}, |
---|
5157 | } |
---|
5158 | |
---|
5159 | @techreport{Forsythe, |
---|
5160 | author = {John C. Reynolds}, |
---|
5161 | title = {Preliminary Design of the Programming Language {Forsythe}}, |
---|
5162 | institution = {Carnegie Mellon University}, |
---|
5163 | number = {CMU-CS-88-159}, |
---|
5164 | month = jun, |
---|
5165 | year = 1988, |
---|
5166 | } |
---|
5167 | |
---|
5168 | @article{PRESTO, |
---|
5169 | keywords = {concurrency, threads}, |
---|
5170 | contributer = {dgharriss@plg}, |
---|
5171 | author = {B. N. Bershad and E. D. Lazowska and H. M. Levy}, |
---|
5172 | title = {{PRESTO}: A System for Object-oriented Parallel Programming}, |
---|
5173 | journal = spe, |
---|
5174 | volume = 18, |
---|
5175 | number = 8, |
---|
5176 | month = aug, |
---|
5177 | year = 1988, |
---|
5178 | pages = {713-732} |
---|
5179 | } |
---|
5180 | |
---|
5181 | @book{Ben-Ari82, |
---|
5182 | keywords = {concurrency, parallel, programming languages}, |
---|
5183 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5184 | author = {Mordechai Ben-Ari}, |
---|
5185 | title = {Principles of Concurrent Programming}, |
---|
5186 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall International}, |
---|
5187 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
5188 | year = 1982, |
---|
5189 | } |
---|
5190 | |
---|
5191 | @book{Tennent81, |
---|
5192 | author = {R. D. Tennent}, |
---|
5193 | title = {Principles of Programming Languages}, |
---|
5194 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall International}, |
---|
5195 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
5196 | year = 1981, |
---|
5197 | series = {Series in Computer Science} |
---|
5198 | } |
---|
5199 | |
---|
5200 | @article{Lister77, |
---|
5201 | keywords = {monitors, nested monitor calls}, |
---|
5202 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5203 | author = {Andrew Lister}, |
---|
5204 | title = {The Problem of Nested Monitor Calls}, |
---|
5205 | journal = osr, |
---|
5206 | volume = 11, |
---|
5207 | number = 3, |
---|
5208 | month = jul, |
---|
5209 | year = 1977, |
---|
5210 | pages = {5-7}, |
---|
5211 | } |
---|
5212 | |
---|
5213 | @article{psa:persistence, |
---|
5214 | keywords = {persistence, first-class procedures, closure, PS-Algol, |
---|
5215 | Abstract Data Types}, |
---|
5216 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5217 | author = {Malcolm P. Atkinson and Ronald Morrison}, |
---|
5218 | title = {Procedures as Persistent Data Objects}, |
---|
5219 | journal = toplas, |
---|
5220 | volume = {7}, number = {4}, |
---|
5221 | pages = {539-559}, |
---|
5222 | month = oct, year = 1985, |
---|
5223 | comment = { |
---|
5224 | PS-Algol has ``structures'', accessible only through ``pntrs''. |
---|
5225 | Pntrs can refer to any type of structure. Field references involve |
---|
5226 | a run-time check. This, plus first-class procedures, can simulate |
---|
5227 | abstract data types. Procedure variables operating on pntrs |
---|
5228 | simulate ADT operations. A block defines a structure to implement |
---|
5229 | the ADT, and assigns procedures to the variables. Functions |
---|
5230 | returning structures containing procedures simulate multiple |
---|
5231 | implementations and parameterized ADTs. |
---|
5232 | |
---|
5233 | An outer procedure that returns a procedure that contains |
---|
5234 | (non-local) references to the outer procedure's parameters |
---|
5235 | implements partial evaluation. |
---|
5236 | |
---|
5237 | Modules can be simulated like ADT's. The module itself is a |
---|
5238 | structure instance that is placed in persistent storage, and the |
---|
5239 | module is imported by fetching it from the persistent store. |
---|
5240 | Multiple instances of modules are easy. Installation of new |
---|
5241 | versions can be done by replacing the version in the database. |
---|
5242 | } |
---|
5243 | } |
---|
5244 | |
---|
5245 | @article{Procol89, |
---|
5246 | keywords = {active objects, object-oriented languages, |
---|
5247 | object-based languages, explicit per-object protocol}, |
---|
5248 | contributer = {akgoel@plg}, |
---|
5249 | author = {Jan van den Bos and Chris Laffra}, |
---|
5250 | title = {PROCOL: A Parallel Object Language with Protocols}, |
---|
5251 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5252 | volume = 24, |
---|
5253 | number = 10, |
---|
5254 | month = oct, |
---|
5255 | year = 1989, |
---|
5256 | pages = {95-102}, |
---|
5257 | note = {Proceedings of the OOPSLA'89 Conference, Oct. 1--6, 1989, New Orleans, Lousiana}, |
---|
5258 | abstract = {}, |
---|
5259 | } |
---|
5260 | |
---|
5261 | @book{Butenhof97, |
---|
5262 | keywords = {PThreads, concurrency}, |
---|
5263 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5264 | author = {David R. Butenhof}, |
---|
5265 | title = {Programming with {POSIX} Threads}, |
---|
5266 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
5267 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
5268 | series = {Professional Computing}, |
---|
5269 | year = 1997, |
---|
5270 | } |
---|
5271 | |
---|
5272 | @book{SETL, |
---|
5273 | keywords = {SETL}, |
---|
5274 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5275 | author = {J. T. Schwartz and R. B. K. Dewar and E. Dubinsky and E. Schonberg}, |
---|
5276 | title = {Programming with Sets: An Introduction to {SETL}}, |
---|
5277 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
5278 | year = 1986, |
---|
5279 | } |
---|
5280 | |
---|
5281 | @book{Genuys68, |
---|
5282 | keywords = {contains Dijkstra's Cooperating Sequential Processes}, |
---|
5283 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5284 | editor = {F. Genuys}, |
---|
5285 | title = {Programming Languages}, |
---|
5286 | publisher = {Academic Press}, |
---|
5287 | address = {London, New York}, |
---|
5288 | year = 1968, |
---|
5289 | note = {NATO Advanced Study Institute, Villard-de-Lans, 1966} |
---|
5290 | } |
---|
5291 | |
---|
5292 | @manual{ANSI99:C, |
---|
5293 | keywords = {ANSI C 99}, |
---|
5294 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5295 | title = {Programming Languages -- {C}}, |
---|
5296 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 9899:1999 (E)}, |
---|
5297 | publisher = {American National Standards Institute}, |
---|
5298 | address = {www.ansi.org}, |
---|
5299 | year = 1999, |
---|
5300 | } |
---|
5301 | |
---|
5302 | @manual{ANSI98:C++, |
---|
5303 | keywords = {ANSI C++ 98}, |
---|
5304 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5305 | key = {C++98}, |
---|
5306 | title = {Programming Languages -- {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
5307 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 14882:1998 (E)}, |
---|
5308 | publisher = {American National Standards Institute}, |
---|
5309 | address = {www.ansi.org}, |
---|
5310 | year = 1998, |
---|
5311 | } |
---|
5312 | |
---|
5313 | @manual{ANSI14:C++, |
---|
5314 | keywords = {ISO/IEC C++ 14}, |
---|
5315 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5316 | key = {C++14}, |
---|
5317 | title = {Programming Languages -- {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
5318 | edition = {4th}, |
---|
5319 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 14882:2014 (E)}, |
---|
5320 | publisher = {International Standard Organization}, |
---|
5321 | address = {http://www.iso.org}, |
---|
5322 | year = 2014, |
---|
5323 | } |
---|
5324 | |
---|
5325 | @manual{MS:VisualC++, |
---|
5326 | keywords = {Microsoft Visual C++}, |
---|
5327 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5328 | title = {Microsoft Visual {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} .NET Language Reference}, |
---|
5329 | organization= {Microsoft Corporation}, |
---|
5330 | year = 2002, |
---|
5331 | note = {Microsoft Press, Redmond, Washington, U.S.A.}, |
---|
5332 | } |
---|
5333 | |
---|
5334 | @article{HasselBring00, |
---|
5335 | keywords = {concurrency, prototyping}, |
---|
5336 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5337 | author = {Wilhelm Hasselbring}, |
---|
5338 | title = {Programming Languages and Systems for Prototyping Concurrent Applications}, |
---|
5339 | journal = acmcs, |
---|
5340 | volume = 32, |
---|
5341 | number = 1, |
---|
5342 | month = mar, |
---|
5343 | year = 2000, |
---|
5344 | pages = {43-79}, |
---|
5345 | } |
---|
5346 | |
---|
5347 | @article{LLgen, |
---|
5348 | keywords = {ll(1), parser generator, separate compilation}, |
---|
5349 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5350 | author = {Dick Grune and Ceriel J. J. Jacobs}, |
---|
5351 | title = {A Programmer-friendly LL(1) Parser Generator}, |
---|
5352 | journal = spe, |
---|
5353 | month = jan, year = 1988, |
---|
5354 | volume = 18, number = 1, pages = {29-33}, |
---|
5355 | comment = { |
---|
5356 | LLgen generates C-language recursive-descent parsers. The input |
---|
5357 | contains procedure-like rules with alternation and repetition |
---|
5358 | constructs on the right, and (typed) parameters on the left. |
---|
5359 | C actions are specified between items in the right side. |
---|
5360 | Alternation and repetition (reduce and shift) conflicts can be |
---|
5361 | resolved statically or at run time. |
---|
5362 | |
---|
5363 | A grammar can be specified in several files. All files must be |
---|
5364 | submitted to LLgen at once, but if the C file generated is no |
---|
5365 | different from the old version, then the old version is not |
---|
5366 | replaced and hence need not be recompiled, which saves lots of |
---|
5367 | time. |
---|
5368 | |
---|
5369 | When an incorrect token is found, the automatic error recovery |
---|
5370 | algorithm discards tokens until an ``acceptable'' token is found; |
---|
5371 | if the acceptable token is not correct, a correct one is inserted. |
---|
5372 | } |
---|
5373 | } |
---|
5374 | |
---|
5375 | @techreport{russell, |
---|
5376 | keywords = {Russell}, |
---|
5377 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5378 | author = {H. Boehm and A. Demers and J. Donahue}, |
---|
5379 | title = {A Programmer's Introduction to Russell}, |
---|
5380 | institution = {Rice University}, |
---|
5381 | year = 1985, |
---|
5382 | number = {85-16} |
---|
5383 | } |
---|
5384 | |
---|
5385 | @techreport{PDM89, |
---|
5386 | keywords = {existential types, universal types}, |
---|
5387 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5388 | author = {Benjamin Pierce and Scott Dietzen and Spiro Michaylov}, |
---|
5389 | title = {Programming in Higher-Order Typed Lambda Calculi}, |
---|
5390 | institution = {School of Computer Science, Carnegie Mellon University}, |
---|
5391 | year = 1989, |
---|
5392 | address = {Pittsburg, PA 15213-3890}, |
---|
5393 | month = mar, number = {CMU-CS-89-111}, |
---|
5394 | abstract = { |
---|
5395 | This tutorial presents a hierarchy of increasingly powerful |
---|
5396 | languages, beginning with Church's simply typed |
---|
5397 | \(\lambda\)-calculus (\(F_1\)) and the second-order polymorphic |
---|
5398 | \(\lambda\)-calculus of Girard and Reynolds, and culminating in a |
---|
5399 | fragment of Girard's \(\omega\)-order polymorphic |
---|
5400 | \(\lambda\)-calculus (\(F_\omega\)). Our focus throughout is on |
---|
5401 | the unusual style of programming that arises in these languages, |
---|
5402 | where all functions are total and the primary control construct is |
---|
5403 | iteration rather than general recursion. |
---|
5404 | } |
---|
5405 | } |
---|
5406 | |
---|
5407 | @book{Modula-2, |
---|
5408 | keywords = {modules, coroutines}, |
---|
5409 | contributer = {pabuhr}, |
---|
5410 | author = {Niklaus Wirth}, |
---|
5411 | title = {Programming in Modula-2}, |
---|
5412 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
5413 | address = {New York}, |
---|
5414 | year = 1988, |
---|
5415 | edition = {4th}, |
---|
5416 | series = {Texts and Monographs in Computer Science}, |
---|
5417 | } |
---|
5418 | |
---|
5419 | @manual{Ada, |
---|
5420 | keywords = {Ada, packages, tasks, exceptions}, |
---|
5421 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5422 | title = {The Programming Language {Ada}: Reference Manual}, |
---|
5423 | organization= {United States Department of Defense}, |
---|
5424 | edition = {{ANSI/MIL-STD-1815A-1983}}, |
---|
5425 | month = feb, |
---|
5426 | year = 1983, |
---|
5427 | note = {Springer, New York}, |
---|
5428 | } |
---|
5429 | |
---|
5430 | @manual{ada:old, |
---|
5431 | keywords = {Ada, packages, tasks, exceptions}, |
---|
5432 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5433 | title = {The Programming Language {Ada}: Reference Manual}, |
---|
5434 | organization= {United States Department of Defense}, |
---|
5435 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
5436 | year = 1981 |
---|
5437 | } |
---|
5438 | |
---|
5439 | @book{Ghezzi, |
---|
5440 | keywords = {}, |
---|
5441 | author = {Carlo Ghezzi and Mehdi Jazayeri}, |
---|
5442 | title = {Programming Language Concepts}, |
---|
5443 | publisher = {Wiley}, |
---|
5444 | year = 1982 |
---|
5445 | } |
---|
5446 | |
---|
5447 | @article{ConcurrentPascal, |
---|
5448 | keywords = {Concurrent Pascal}, |
---|
5449 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5450 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}}, |
---|
5451 | title = {The Programming Language Concurrent Pascal}, |
---|
5452 | journal = ieeese, |
---|
5453 | volume = 2, |
---|
5454 | month = jun, |
---|
5455 | year = 1975, |
---|
5456 | pages = {199-206} |
---|
5457 | } |
---|
5458 | |
---|
5459 | @phdthesis{Buhr85:thesis, |
---|
5460 | keywords = {}, |
---|
5461 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5462 | author = {P. A. Buhr}, |
---|
5463 | title = {A Programming System}, |
---|
5464 | school = {University of Manitoba}, |
---|
5465 | year = {1985} |
---|
5466 | } |
---|
5467 | |
---|
5468 | @techreport{pierce91, |
---|
5469 | keywords = {typed lambda calculus}, |
---|
5470 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5471 | author = {Benjamin C. Pierce}, |
---|
5472 | title = {Programming with Intersection Types, Union Types, and Polymorphism}, |
---|
5473 | institution = {Carnegie Mellon University}, |
---|
5474 | year = 1991, |
---|
5475 | month = feb, number = "CMU-CS-91-106", |
---|
5476 | annote = { |
---|
5477 | Discusses a typed lambda calculus with |
---|
5478 | \begin{itemize} |
---|
5479 | \item |
---|
5480 | Intersection types \(\tau = \tau_1\wedge\tau_2\) with \(\tau \le |
---|
5481 | \tau_i\) for all \(i\). |
---|
5482 | \item |
---|
5483 | Union types \(\tau = \tau_1\vee\tau_2\) with \(\tau_i \le \tau\), |
---|
5484 | and with implicit coercions from \(tau_i\) to \(\tau\). Only |
---|
5485 | operations valid for both element types can be applied to the |
---|
5486 | union; there are no projections. Union types are to variant |
---|
5487 | records as set union is to disjoint set union. |
---|
5488 | \item |
---|
5489 | Function types and universal quantification, with subtyping rules. |
---|
5490 | When functions and arguments intersections, the result of |
---|
5491 | application is the intersection of all valid combinations. |
---|
5492 | \item |
---|
5493 | Distribution rules for combinations of types. |
---|
5494 | \item |
---|
5495 | "Union elimination": "case \(x = e\) of \(e'\)", where \(e\) is a |
---|
5496 | union, has type \(\tau\) if \(e'\) has that type with \(x\) having |
---|
5497 | every element type of the union. |
---|
5498 | \item |
---|
5499 | "Finitary quantification": "for \(t\) in \(\tau_1,\ldots,\tau_n.e\)" |
---|
5500 | typechecks \(e\) with \(t\) bound to each choice, and intersects |
---|
5501 | the results. |
---|
5502 | \end{itemize} |
---|
5503 | |
---|
5504 | Examples include: type of "natural" numbers, treated as a union of |
---|
5505 | "zero" and "positive" types; default parameters, faked by using an |
---|
5506 | argument that is an intersection of a data type and a function |
---|
5507 | taking an explicit argument. |
---|
5508 | |
---|
5509 | Unions can be mostly faked, according to Mitchell: |
---|
5510 | \[\tau_1\vee\tau_2 \equiv |
---|
5511 | \forall\tau.(\tau_1\on\tau)\wedge(\tau_2\on\tau)\] |
---|
5512 | } |
---|
5513 | } |
---|
5514 | |
---|
5515 | @article{promises, |
---|
5516 | keywords = {futures, Argus, call streams, rpc}, |
---|
5517 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5518 | author = {Barbara Liskov and Liuba Shrira}, |
---|
5519 | title = {Promises: Linguistic Support for Efficient Asynchronous |
---|
5520 | Procedure Calls in Distributed Systems}, |
---|
5521 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5522 | year = 1988, |
---|
5523 | month = jul, volume = 23, number = 7, pages = {260-267}, |
---|
5524 | note = {Proceedings of the SIGPLAN '88 Conference on Programming Language |
---|
5525 | Design and Implementation}, |
---|
5526 | abstract = { |
---|
5527 | This paper deals with the integration of an efficient asynchronous |
---|
5528 | remote procedure call mechanism into a programming language. It |
---|
5529 | describes a new data type called a {\em promise} that was designed |
---|
5530 | to support asynchronous calls. Promises allow a caller to run in |
---|
5531 | parallel with a call and to pick up the results of the call, |
---|
5532 | including any exceptions it raises, in a convenient and type-safe |
---|
5533 | manner. The paper also discusses efficient composition of |
---|
5534 | sequences of asynchronous calls to different locations in a |
---|
5535 | network. |
---|
5536 | } |
---|
5537 | } |
---|
5538 | |
---|
5539 | @article{Cook89, |
---|
5540 | keywords = {}, |
---|
5541 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5542 | author = {W. R. Cook}, |
---|
5543 | title = {A Proposal for Making {Eiffel} Type-safe}, |
---|
5544 | journal = {The Computer Journal}, |
---|
5545 | year = 1989, |
---|
5546 | volume = 32, number = 4, pages = {305-311}, |
---|
5547 | abstract = { |
---|
5548 | |
---|
5549 | } |
---|
5550 | } |
---|
5551 | |
---|
5552 | @inproceedings{Foxall79, |
---|
5553 | keywords = {}, |
---|
5554 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5555 | author = {D. G. Foxall and M. L. Joliat and R. F. Kamel and J. J. Miceli}, |
---|
5556 | title = {{PROTEL}: A High Level Language for Telephony}, |
---|
5557 | booktitle = {Proceedings 3rd International Computer Software and Applications Conference}, |
---|
5558 | month = nov, |
---|
5559 | year = 1979, |
---|
5560 | pages = {193-197}, |
---|
5561 | } |
---|
5562 | |
---|
5563 | @techreport{PS-Algol, |
---|
5564 | keywords = {algol, persistence}, |
---|
5565 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5566 | key = {PS-Algol}, |
---|
5567 | title = {The {PS-Algol} Reference Manual, 4th Ed.}, |
---|
5568 | author = {}, |
---|
5569 | institution = {University of Glasgow and St. Andrews, Scotland}, |
---|
5570 | number = {PPRR 12}, |
---|
5571 | month = jun, |
---|
5572 | year = 1987, |
---|
5573 | } |
---|
5574 | |
---|
5575 | @manual{Python, |
---|
5576 | keywords = {Python}, |
---|
5577 | contributer = {pabuhr}, |
---|
5578 | title = {Python Reference Manual, Release 2.5}, |
---|
5579 | author = {Guido van Rossum}, |
---|
5580 | organization= {Python Software Foundation}, |
---|
5581 | month = sep, |
---|
5582 | year = 2006, |
---|
5583 | note = {Fred L. Drake, Jr., editor}, |
---|
5584 | } |
---|
5585 | |
---|
5586 | % Q |
---|
5587 | |
---|
5588 | @article{Grossman06, |
---|
5589 | keywords = {Cyclone, existential types, polymorphism, type variables}, |
---|
5590 | contributer = {a3moss@plg}, |
---|
5591 | author = {Grossman, Dan}, |
---|
5592 | title = {Quantified Types in an Imperative Language}, |
---|
5593 | journal = toplas, |
---|
5594 | issue_date = {May 2006}, |
---|
5595 | volume = {28}, |
---|
5596 | number = {3}, |
---|
5597 | month = may, |
---|
5598 | year = {2006}, |
---|
5599 | issn = {0164-0925}, |
---|
5600 | pages = {429--475}, |
---|
5601 | numpages = {47}, |
---|
5602 | url = {http://doi.acm.org.proxy.lib.uwaterloo.ca/10.1145/1133651.1133653}, |
---|
5603 | doi = {10.1145/1133651.1133653}, |
---|
5604 | acmid = {1133653}, |
---|
5605 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
5606 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
5607 | } |
---|
5608 | |
---|
5609 | @article{Hoare61, |
---|
5610 | keywords = {quick sort}, |
---|
5611 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5612 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare}, |
---|
5613 | title = {Algorithms 63/64: Partition/Quicksort}, |
---|
5614 | journal = cacm, |
---|
5615 | volume = 4, |
---|
5616 | number = 7, |
---|
5617 | month = jul, |
---|
5618 | year = 1961, |
---|
5619 | pages = {321}, |
---|
5620 | } |
---|
5621 | |
---|
5622 | % R |
---|
5623 | |
---|
5624 | @article{Ada:rationale:preliminary, |
---|
5625 | keywords = {Ada}, |
---|
5626 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5627 | author = {J. D. Ichbiah and J. C. Heliard and O. Roubine and |
---|
5628 | J. G. P. Barnes and B. Krieg-Brueckner and B. A. Wichmann}, |
---|
5629 | title = {Rationale for the Design of the {ADA} Programming Language}, |
---|
5630 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5631 | volume = 14, |
---|
5632 | number = 6, |
---|
5633 | month = jun, |
---|
5634 | year = 1979, |
---|
5635 | note = {Part B}, |
---|
5636 | } |
---|
5637 | |
---|
5638 | @book{Ada:rationale, |
---|
5639 | keywords = {Ada}, |
---|
5640 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5641 | author = {Jean D. Ichbiah and John G. P. Barnes and Robert J. Firth and Mike Woodger}, |
---|
5642 | title = {Rationale for the Design of the {ADA} Programming Language}, |
---|
5643 | publisher = {Under Secretary of Defense, Research and Engineering}, |
---|
5644 | year = 1986, |
---|
5645 | address = {Ada Joint Program Office, OUSDRE(R\&AT), The Pentagon, Washington, D. C., 20301, U.S.A.}, |
---|
5646 | } |
---|
5647 | |
---|
5648 | @manual{Ada95, |
---|
5649 | keywords = {Ada}, |
---|
5650 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5651 | title = {{A}da Reference Manual}, |
---|
5652 | edition = {International Standard {ISO}/{IEC} {8652:1995(E)} with {COR.1:2000}}, |
---|
5653 | organization= {Intermetrics, Inc.}, |
---|
5654 | month = dec, |
---|
5655 | year = 1995, |
---|
5656 | note = {Language and Standards Libraries} |
---|
5657 | } |
---|
5658 | |
---|
5659 | @manual{Ada12, |
---|
5660 | keywords = {Ada}, |
---|
5661 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5662 | title = {Programming languages -- {Ada}}, |
---|
5663 | edition = {3rd}, |
---|
5664 | organization= {International Standard ISO/IEC 1989:2014}, |
---|
5665 | publisher = {International Standard Organization}, |
---|
5666 | address = {http://www.iso.org}, |
---|
5667 | year = 2012, |
---|
5668 | } |
---|
5669 | |
---|
5670 | @manual{Ada95:annotated, |
---|
5671 | keywords = {Ada}, |
---|
5672 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5673 | title = {Annotated {A}da Reference Manual}, |
---|
5674 | edition = {International Standard {ISO}/{IEC} {8652:1995(E)} with {COR.1:2000}}, |
---|
5675 | organization = {Intermetrics, Inc.}, |
---|
5676 | month = dec, |
---|
5677 | year = 1995, |
---|
5678 | note = {Language and Standards Libraries} |
---|
5679 | } |
---|
5680 | |
---|
5681 | @book{JavaRT00, |
---|
5682 | keywords = {real time, draft}, |
---|
5683 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5684 | author = {Greg Bollella and Ben Brosgol and Peter Dibble and Steve Furr and James Gosling and David Hardin and Mark Turnbull}, |
---|
5685 | title = {The Real-Time Specification for {J}ava}, |
---|
5686 | series = {The Real-Time for Java Expert Group, {\small\textsf{http://\-www.rtj.org}}}, |
---|
5687 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
5688 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
5689 | year = 2000, |
---|
5690 | } |
---|
5691 | |
---|
5692 | @manual{JavaRT99, |
---|
5693 | organization= {Real Time for Java Experts Group}, |
---|
5694 | address = {{\small\textsf{http://\-www.rtj.org}}}, |
---|
5695 | month = sep, |
---|
5696 | year = 1999, |
---|
5697 | } |
---|
5698 | |
---|
5699 | @article{Robinson48, |
---|
5700 | keywords = {recursion, Ackermann function}, |
---|
5701 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5702 | author = {Raphael Mitchel Robinson}, |
---|
5703 | title = {Recursion and Double Recursion}, |
---|
5704 | publisher = {American Mathematical Society}, |
---|
5705 | journal = {Bulletin of the American Mathematical Society}, |
---|
5706 | volume = 54, |
---|
5707 | pages = {987-993}, |
---|
5708 | year = 1948, |
---|
5709 | } |
---|
5710 | |
---|
5711 | @article{Dijkstra:red, |
---|
5712 | keywords = {ada}, |
---|
5713 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5714 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra}, |
---|
5715 | title = {On the RED Language submitted to the DoD}, |
---|
5716 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5717 | year = 1978, |
---|
5718 | month = oct, |
---|
5719 | volume = 13, |
---|
5720 | number = 10, |
---|
5721 | pages = {27-32}, |
---|
5722 | } |
---|
5723 | |
---|
5724 | @article{RemoteRendezvous, |
---|
5725 | keywords = {rendezvous, concurrency}, |
---|
5726 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5727 | author = {N. D. Gammage and R. F. Kamel and L. M. Casey}, |
---|
5728 | title = {Remote Rendezvous}, |
---|
5729 | journal = spe, |
---|
5730 | month = oct, |
---|
5731 | year = 1987, |
---|
5732 | volume = 17, |
---|
5733 | number = 10, |
---|
5734 | pages = {741-755} |
---|
5735 | } |
---|
5736 | |
---|
5737 | @article{Euclid, |
---|
5738 | keywords = {Euclid}, |
---|
5739 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5740 | author = {B. W. Lampson and J. J. Horning and R. L. London and J. G. Mitchell and G. L. Popek}, |
---|
5741 | title = {Report on the Programming Language Euclid}, |
---|
5742 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5743 | volume = 12, |
---|
5744 | number = 2, |
---|
5745 | month = feb, |
---|
5746 | year = 1977, |
---|
5747 | pages = {1-79} |
---|
5748 | } |
---|
5749 | |
---|
5750 | @techreport{LOGLAN88, |
---|
5751 | keywords = {LOGLAN}, |
---|
5752 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5753 | author = {Boleslaw Ciesielski and Antoni Kreczmar and Marek Lao and Andrzej Litwiniuk and Teresa Przytycka and Andrzej Salwicki and Jolanta Warpechowska and Marek Warpechowski and Andrzej Szalas and Danuta Szczepanska--Wasersztrum}, |
---|
5754 | title = {Report on the Programming Language LOGLAN'88}, |
---|
5755 | institution = {Institute of Informatics, University of Warsaw}, |
---|
5756 | address = {Pkin 8th Floor, 00-901 Warsaw, Poland}, |
---|
5757 | number = {}, |
---|
5758 | month = dec, |
---|
5759 | year = 1988, |
---|
5760 | } |
---|
5761 | |
---|
5762 | @article{FH91, |
---|
5763 | keywords = {lcc}, |
---|
5764 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5765 | author = {Christopher W. Fraser and David R. Hanson}, |
---|
5766 | title = {A Retargetable Compiler for {ANSI} {C}}, |
---|
5767 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5768 | year = 1991, |
---|
5769 | month = oct, volume = 26, number = 10, pages = {29-43}, |
---|
5770 | abstract = { |
---|
5771 | {\tt lcc} is a new retargetable compiler for ANSI C. Versions for |
---|
5772 | the VAX, Motorola 68020, SPARC, and MIPS are in production use at |
---|
5773 | Princeton University and at AT\&T Bell Laboratories. With a few |
---|
5774 | exceptions, little about {\tt lcc} is unusual---it integrates |
---|
5775 | several well engineered, existing techniques---but it is smaller |
---|
5776 | and faster than most other C compilers, and it generates code of |
---|
5777 | comparable quality. {\tt lcc}'s target-independent front end |
---|
5778 | performs a few simple, but effective, optimizations that contribute |
---|
5779 | to good code; examples include simulating register declarations and |
---|
5780 | partitioning switch statements into dense tables. It also |
---|
5781 | implements target-independent function tracing and expression-level |
---|
5782 | profiling. |
---|
5783 | } |
---|
5784 | } |
---|
5785 | |
---|
5786 | @article{Algol68revised, |
---|
5787 | keywords = {}, |
---|
5788 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5789 | author = {A. van Wijngaarden and B. J. Mailloux and J. E. L. Peck and |
---|
5790 | C. H. A. Koster and M. Sintzoff and C. H. Lindsey and L. G. L. T. |
---|
5791 | Meertens and R. G. Fisher}, |
---|
5792 | title = {Revised Report on the Algorithmic Language {ALGOL} 68}, |
---|
5793 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5794 | year = 1977, |
---|
5795 | month = may, |
---|
5796 | volume = 12, |
---|
5797 | number = 5, |
---|
5798 | pages = {1-70} |
---|
5799 | } |
---|
5800 | |
---|
5801 | @article{scheme, |
---|
5802 | keywords = {}, |
---|
5803 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5804 | author = {Jonathan Rees and William Clinger}, |
---|
5805 | title = {Revised$^3$ Report on the Algorithmic Language {S}cheme}, |
---|
5806 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5807 | year = 1986, |
---|
5808 | month = dec, |
---|
5809 | volume = 21, |
---|
5810 | number = 12, |
---|
5811 | pages = {37-79}, |
---|
5812 | } |
---|
5813 | |
---|
5814 | @article{scheme5, |
---|
5815 | keywords = {scheme}, |
---|
5816 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5817 | author = {H. Abelson and Adams, IV, N. I. and D. H. Bartley and G. Brooks and R. K. Dybvig and D. P. Friedman and |
---|
5818 | R. Halstead and C. Hanson and C. T. Haynes and E. Kohlbecker and D. Oxley and K. M. Pitman and G. J. Rozas and |
---|
5819 | G. L. Steele Jr. and G. J. Sussman and M. Wand and \emph{Ed. by} Richard Kelsey and William Clinger and Jonathan Rees}, |
---|
5820 | title = {Revised$^5$ Report on the Algorithmic Language {S}cheme}, |
---|
5821 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
5822 | year = 1998, |
---|
5823 | month = sep, |
---|
5824 | volume = 33, |
---|
5825 | number = 9, |
---|
5826 | pages = {26-76}, |
---|
5827 | } |
---|
5828 | |
---|
5829 | @manual{Rust, |
---|
5830 | keywords = {Rust programming language}, |
---|
5831 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5832 | title = {The {Rust} Programming Language}, |
---|
5833 | organization= {The Rust Project Developers}, |
---|
5834 | year = 2015, |
---|
5835 | note = {\href{https://doc.rust-lang.org/reference.html}{https://\-doc.rust-lang.org/\-reference.html}}, |
---|
5836 | } |
---|
5837 | |
---|
5838 | % S |
---|
5839 | |
---|
5840 | @manual{Scala, |
---|
5841 | keywords = {Scala programming language}, |
---|
5842 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5843 | title = {{Scala} Language Specification, Version 2.11}, |
---|
5844 | organization= {\'{E}cole Polytechnique F\'{e}d\'{e}rale de Lausanne}, |
---|
5845 | year = 2016, |
---|
5846 | note = {\href{http://www.scala-lang.org/files/archive/spec/2.11}{http://\-www.scala-lang.org/\-files/\-archive/\-spec/\-2.11}}, |
---|
5847 | } |
---|
5848 | |
---|
5849 | @inproceedings{Michael04, |
---|
5850 | keywords = {lock free, dynamic memory allocation}, |
---|
5851 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5852 | author = {Maged M. Michael}, |
---|
5853 | title = {Scalable Lock-free Dynamic Memory Allocation}, |
---|
5854 | booktitle = {PLDI '04: Proceedings of the ACM SIGPLAN 2004 Conference on Programming Language Design and Implementation}, |
---|
5855 | location = {Washington DC, USA}, |
---|
5856 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
5857 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
5858 | volume = 39, |
---|
5859 | year = 2004, |
---|
5860 | month = jun, |
---|
5861 | pages = {35-46}, |
---|
5862 | } |
---|
5863 | |
---|
5864 | @article{Anderson92, |
---|
5865 | keywords = {light-weight tasks}, |
---|
5866 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5867 | author = {Thomas E. Anderson and Brian N. Bershad and Edward D. Lazowska and Henry M. Levy}, |
---|
5868 | title = {Scheduler Activations: Effective Kernel Support for the User-Level Management of Parallelism}, |
---|
5869 | journal = tocs, |
---|
5870 | volume = 10, |
---|
5871 | number = 1, |
---|
5872 | month = feb, |
---|
5873 | year = 1992, |
---|
5874 | pages = {53-79}, |
---|
5875 | } |
---|
5876 | |
---|
5877 | @manual{SELF, |
---|
5878 | keywords = {programming language, obect-oriented, polymorphism}, |
---|
5879 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5880 | author = {Ole Agesen and Lars Bak and Craig Chambers and Bay-Wei Chang and Urs H{\o}lzle |
---|
5881 | and John H. Maloney and Randall B. Smith and David Ungar and Mario Wolczko}, |
---|
5882 | title = {The {SELF} 3.0 Programmer's Reference Manual}, |
---|
5883 | organization= {Sun Microsystems, Inc., and Stanford University}, |
---|
5884 | year = 1993, |
---|
5885 | } |
---|
5886 | |
---|
5887 | @inproceedings{Cardelli84, |
---|
5888 | keywords = {subtypes, recursive types, records, variants, object oriented}, |
---|
5889 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
5890 | author = {Luca Cardelli}, |
---|
5891 | title = {A Semantics of Multiple Inheritance}, |
---|
5892 | booktitle = {Semantics of Data Types}, |
---|
5893 | year = 1984, |
---|
5894 | pages = {51-67}, |
---|
5895 | editor = {G. Kahn and D. B. MacQueen and G. D. Plotkin}, |
---|
5896 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
5897 | note = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science v. 173}, |
---|
5898 | } |
---|
5899 | |
---|
5900 | @techreport{Adve95, |
---|
5901 | keywords = {shared memory, consistency models}, |
---|
5902 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5903 | author = {Sarita V. Adve and Kourosh Gharachorloo}, |
---|
5904 | title = {Shared Memory Consistency Models: A Tutorial}, |
---|
5905 | institution = {Western Research Laboratory}, |
---|
5906 | address = {250 University Avenue, Palo Alto, California, 94301, U.S.A.}, |
---|
5907 | number = {7}, |
---|
5908 | month = sep, |
---|
5909 | year = 1995, |
---|
5910 | note = {\href{http://www.hpl.hp.com/techreports/Compaq-DEC/WRL-95-7.pdf}{\textsf{http://www.hpl.hp.com/\-techreports/\-Compaq-DEC/\-WRL-95-7.pdf}}, Reprinted in \cite{Adve95reprint}.}, |
---|
5911 | } |
---|
5912 | |
---|
5913 | @article{Adve95reprint, |
---|
5914 | keywords = {shared memory, consistency models}, |
---|
5915 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5916 | author = {Sarita V. Adve and Kourosh Gharachorloo}, |
---|
5917 | journal = {Computer}, |
---|
5918 | title = {Shared Memory Consistency Models: A Tutorial}, |
---|
5919 | month = dec, |
---|
5920 | year = 1996, |
---|
5921 | volume = 29, |
---|
5922 | number = 12, |
---|
5923 | pages = {66-76}, |
---|
5924 | } |
---|
5925 | |
---|
5926 | @inproceedings{Howard76b, |
---|
5927 | keywords = {monitors}, |
---|
5928 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5929 | author = {J. H. Howard}, |
---|
5930 | title = {Signaling in Monitors}, |
---|
5931 | booktitle = {Proceedings Second International Conference Software Engineering}, |
---|
5932 | address = {San Francisco, U.S.A}, |
---|
5933 | publisher = {IEEE Computer Society}, |
---|
5934 | month = oct, |
---|
5935 | year = 1976, |
---|
5936 | pages = {47-52} |
---|
5937 | } |
---|
5938 | |
---|
5939 | @techreport{Schemenauer01, |
---|
5940 | keywords = {Phthon, generator, coroutine}, |
---|
5941 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5942 | author = {Neil Schemenauer and Tim Peters and Magnus Lie Hetland}, |
---|
5943 | title = {Simple Generators}, |
---|
5944 | month = may, |
---|
5945 | year = 2001, |
---|
5946 | note = {\href{http://www.python.org/peps/pep-0255.html}{http://\-www.python.org/\-peps/\-pep-0255.html}}, |
---|
5947 | } |
---|
5948 | |
---|
5949 | @inproceedings{Michael96, |
---|
5950 | keywords = {compare_and_swap, concurrent queue, lock-free, multiprogramming, non-blocking}, |
---|
5951 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
5952 | author = {Maged M. Michael and Michael L. Scott}, |
---|
5953 | title = {Simple, Fast, and Practical Non-blocking and Blocking Concurrent Queue Algorithms}, |
---|
5954 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Fifteenth Annual ACM Symposium on Principles of Distributed Computing}, |
---|
5955 | series = {PODC'96}, |
---|
5956 | year = 1996, |
---|
5957 | location = {Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, USA}, |
---|
5958 | pages = {267--275}, |
---|
5959 | numpages = {9}, |
---|
5960 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
5961 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
5962 | } |
---|
5963 | |
---|
5964 | @article{Pennello80, |
---|
5965 | contributer = {a3moss@uwaterloo.ca}, |
---|
5966 | author = {Pennello, Tom and DeRemer, Frank and Meyers, Richard}, |
---|
5967 | title = {A Simplified Operator Identification Scheme for {Ada}}, |
---|
5968 | journal = {SIGPLAN Notices}, |
---|
5969 | issue_date = {July-August 1980}, |
---|
5970 | volume = {15}, |
---|
5971 | number = {7 and 8}, |
---|
5972 | month = jul, |
---|
5973 | year = {1980}, |
---|
5974 | issn = {0362-1340}, |
---|
5975 | pages = {82--87}, |
---|
5976 | numpages = {6}, |
---|
5977 | url = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/947680.947688}, |
---|
5978 | doi = {10.1145/947680.947688}, |
---|
5979 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
5980 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
5981 | } |
---|
5982 | |
---|
5983 | @inproceedings{Dice10, |
---|
5984 | keywords = {hardware, synchronization, transactional memory}, |
---|
5985 | author = {Dave Dice and Yossi Lev and Virendra J. Marathe and Mark Moir and Dan Nussbaum and Marek Olszewski}, |
---|
5986 | title = {Simplifying Concurrent Algorithms by Exploiting Hardware Transactional Memory}, |
---|
5987 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Twenty-second Annual ACM Symposium on Parallelism in Algorithms and Architectures}, |
---|
5988 | series = {SPAA'10}, |
---|
5989 | year = 2010, |
---|
5990 | location = {Thira, Santorini, Greece}, |
---|
5991 | pages = {325-334}, |
---|
5992 | numpages = {10}, |
---|
5993 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
5994 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
5995 | } |
---|
5996 | |
---|
5997 | @article{PDM:overload, |
---|
5998 | keywords = {compilation}, |
---|
5999 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6000 | author = {Tom Pennello and Frank DeRemer and Richard Meyers}, |
---|
6001 | title = {A Simplified Operator Identification Scheme for {Ada}}, |
---|
6002 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
6003 | year = 1980, |
---|
6004 | month = {July--August}, |
---|
6005 | volume = 15, |
---|
6006 | number = {7/8}, |
---|
6007 | pages = {82-87}, |
---|
6008 | comment = { |
---|
6009 | The two-pass (bottom-up, top-down) overload resolution algorithm |
---|
6010 | for Ada, with a proof that two passes suffice and a claim that two |
---|
6011 | are necessary. See \cite{D:overload}. |
---|
6012 | } |
---|
6013 | } |
---|
6014 | |
---|
6015 | @book{SimulaBegin, |
---|
6016 | author = {Graham M. Birtwistle and Ole-Johan Dahl and Bj{\o}rn Myhrhaug and Kristen Nygaard}, |
---|
6017 | title = {{SIMULA} begin}, |
---|
6018 | publisher = {Studentlitteratur}, |
---|
6019 | year = {1980}, |
---|
6020 | address = {Lund, Sweden}, |
---|
6021 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
6022 | } |
---|
6023 | |
---|
6024 | @book{Simula67, |
---|
6025 | author = {O-J Dahl and B. Myhrhaug and K. Nygaard}, |
---|
6026 | title = {Simula67 Common Base Language}, |
---|
6027 | month = oct, |
---|
6028 | year = 1970, |
---|
6029 | publisher = {Norwegian Com\-puting Center}, |
---|
6030 | address = {Oslo Norway}, |
---|
6031 | } |
---|
6032 | |
---|
6033 | @book{smalltalk, |
---|
6034 | keywords = {Smalltalk, abstract class, protocol}, |
---|
6035 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6036 | author = {A. Goldberg and D. Robson}, |
---|
6037 | title = {Smalltalk-80: The Language and its Implementation}, |
---|
6038 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
6039 | address = {Reading}, |
---|
6040 | year = 1983 |
---|
6041 | } |
---|
6042 | |
---|
6043 | @inproceedings{Edelson92, |
---|
6044 | keywords = {persistence, pointers}, |
---|
6045 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6046 | author = {Daniel R. Edelson}, |
---|
6047 | title = {Smart Pointers: They're Smart, but They're Not Pointers}, |
---|
6048 | booktitle = {USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Technical Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
6049 | organization= {USENIX Association}, |
---|
6050 | address = {Portland, Oregon, U.S.A.}, |
---|
6051 | month = aug, |
---|
6052 | year = 1992, |
---|
6053 | pages = {1-19}, |
---|
6054 | } |
---|
6055 | |
---|
6056 | @book{SNOBOL, |
---|
6057 | keywords = {SNOBOL4}, |
---|
6058 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6059 | author = {R. E. Griswold and J. F. Poage and I. P. Polonsky}, |
---|
6060 | title = {The SNOBOL4 Programming Language}, |
---|
6061 | edition = {2nd}, |
---|
6062 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
6063 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
6064 | year = 1971, |
---|
6065 | } |
---|
6066 | |
---|
6067 | @article{Sutter05b, |
---|
6068 | keywords = {concurrency}, |
---|
6069 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6070 | author = {Herb Sutter and James Larus}, |
---|
6071 | title = {Software and the Concurrency Revolution}, |
---|
6072 | journal = Queue, |
---|
6073 | year = 2005, |
---|
6074 | month = sep, |
---|
6075 | volume = 3, |
---|
6076 | number = 7, |
---|
6077 | pages = {54-62}, |
---|
6078 | } |
---|
6079 | |
---|
6080 | @inproceedings{raytheon, |
---|
6081 | keywords = {cobol}, |
---|
6082 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6083 | author = {Robert G. Lanergan and Charles A. Grasso}, |
---|
6084 | title = {Software Engineering with Reusable Designs and Code}, |
---|
6085 | booktitle = {Workshop on Reusability in Programming}, |
---|
6086 | year = 1983, |
---|
6087 | month = sep, |
---|
6088 | pages = {224-234}, |
---|
6089 | organization= {{ITT} Programming}, |
---|
6090 | summary = { |
---|
6091 | 60\% of business application design and code are redundant. |
---|
6092 | Three standard program plans are used. Reuse doubles productivity |
---|
6093 | during development and greatly helps program comprehension during |
---|
6094 | maintenance. |
---|
6095 | } |
---|
6096 | } |
---|
6097 | |
---|
6098 | @article{Hecht86, |
---|
6099 | keywords = {exception handling, robustness}, |
---|
6100 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6101 | author = {H. Hecht and M. Hecht}, |
---|
6102 | title = {Software Reliability in the Systems Context}, |
---|
6103 | journal = ieeese, |
---|
6104 | year = 1986, |
---|
6105 | volume = 12, |
---|
6106 | number = 1, |
---|
6107 | pages = {51-58}, |
---|
6108 | } |
---|
6109 | |
---|
6110 | @inproceedings{Herlihy03, |
---|
6111 | author = {Maurice Herlihy and Victor Luchangco and Mark Moir and William N. {Scherer III}}, |
---|
6112 | title = {Software Transactional Memory for Dynamic-sized Data Structures}, |
---|
6113 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Twenty-second Annual Symposium on Principles of Distributed Computing}, |
---|
6114 | series = {PODC '03}, |
---|
6115 | year = {2003}, |
---|
6116 | location = {Boston, Massachusetts}, |
---|
6117 | pages = {92-101}, |
---|
6118 | numpages = {10}, |
---|
6119 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
6120 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
6121 | } |
---|
6122 | |
---|
6123 | @article{Dijkstra65a, |
---|
6124 | keywords = {N-thread software-solution mutual exclusion}, |
---|
6125 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6126 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra}, |
---|
6127 | title = {Solution of a Problem in Concurrent Programming Control}, |
---|
6128 | journal = cacm, |
---|
6129 | volume = 8, |
---|
6130 | number = 9, |
---|
6131 | month = sep, |
---|
6132 | year = 1965, |
---|
6133 | pages = {569}, |
---|
6134 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
6135 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
6136 | } |
---|
6137 | |
---|
6138 | @inproceedings{Chen05, |
---|
6139 | keywords = {fixed-priority, preemption}, |
---|
6140 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6141 | author = {Jiongxiong Chen and Ashif Harji and Peter Buhr}, |
---|
6142 | title = {Solution Space for Fixed-Priority with Preemption Threshold}, |
---|
6143 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 11th Real Time and Embedded Technology and Applications Symposium (RTAS'05)}, |
---|
6144 | organization= {IEEE}, |
---|
6145 | address = {San Francisco, CA, U.S.A}, |
---|
6146 | month = mar, |
---|
6147 | year = 2005, |
---|
6148 | pages = {385-394} |
---|
6149 | } |
---|
6150 | |
---|
6151 | @inproceedings{Tiemann88, |
---|
6152 | keywords = {wrappers}, |
---|
6153 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6154 | author = {Michael D. Tiemann}, |
---|
6155 | title = {Solving the RPC problem in GNU {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
6156 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the USENIX {C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}} Conference}, |
---|
6157 | organization= {USENIX Association}, |
---|
6158 | address = {Denver, Colorado, U.S.A}, |
---|
6159 | month = oct, |
---|
6160 | year = 1988, |
---|
6161 | pages = {343-361} |
---|
6162 | } |
---|
6163 | |
---|
6164 | @book{Campbell74, |
---|
6165 | keywords = {path expressions}, |
---|
6166 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6167 | author = {R. H. Campbell and A. N. Habermann}, |
---|
6168 | title = {The Specification of Process Synchronization by Path Expressions}, |
---|
6169 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
6170 | year = 1974, |
---|
6171 | volume = 16, |
---|
6172 | pages = {89-102}, |
---|
6173 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science}, |
---|
6174 | } |
---|
6175 | |
---|
6176 | @article{Bentley85, |
---|
6177 | keywords = {CSP, concurrency}, |
---|
6178 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6179 | author = {J. Bentley}, |
---|
6180 | title = {A Spelling Checker}, |
---|
6181 | journal = cacm, |
---|
6182 | month = may, |
---|
6183 | year = 1985, |
---|
6184 | volume = 28, |
---|
6185 | number = 5, |
---|
6186 | pages = {456-462}, |
---|
6187 | } |
---|
6188 | |
---|
6189 | @manual{POSIX01, |
---|
6190 | keywords = {POSIX, Standard}, |
---|
6191 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6192 | key = {POSIX}, |
---|
6193 | title = {1003.1 Standard for Information Technology -- Portable Operating System Interface (POSIX), System Interface, Issue 6}, |
---|
6194 | organization= {IEEE and The Open Group}, |
---|
6195 | year = 2001, |
---|
6196 | } |
---|
6197 | |
---|
6198 | @manual{POSIX08, |
---|
6199 | keywords = {POSIX, Standard}, |
---|
6200 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6201 | key = {POSIX}, |
---|
6202 | title = {1003.1 Standard for Information Technology -- Portable Operating System Interface (POSIX), Base Specifications, Issue 7}, |
---|
6203 | organization= {IEEE and The Open Group}, |
---|
6204 | year = 2008, |
---|
6205 | } |
---|
6206 | |
---|
6207 | @inproceedings{ML:NJ, |
---|
6208 | keywords = {continuations, ML}, |
---|
6209 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6210 | author = {A. Appel and D. MacQueen}, |
---|
6211 | title = {A Standard {ML} Compiler}, |
---|
6212 | booktitle = {Functional Programming Languages and Computer Architecture}, |
---|
6213 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
6214 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science}, |
---|
6215 | volume = 274, |
---|
6216 | year = 1987, |
---|
6217 | pages = {301-324}, |
---|
6218 | } |
---|
6219 | |
---|
6220 | @techreport{MLreport, |
---|
6221 | keywords = {ML, polymorphism}, |
---|
6222 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6223 | author = {R. Milner}, |
---|
6224 | title = {The Standard {ML} Core Language}, |
---|
6225 | institution = {}, |
---|
6226 | number = {Polymorphism II.2}, |
---|
6227 | month = oct, |
---|
6228 | year = 1985 |
---|
6229 | } |
---|
6230 | |
---|
6231 | @inproceedings{Ghelli, |
---|
6232 | keywords = {}, |
---|
6233 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6234 | author = {Giorgio Ghelli}, |
---|
6235 | title = {A Static Type System for Message Passing}, |
---|
6236 | crossref = "OOPSLA91", |
---|
6237 | pages = {129-145}, |
---|
6238 | summary = { |
---|
6239 | A strong, statically checked type system for object oriented |
---|
6240 | languages is defined by modelling methods as overloaded functions |
---|
6241 | with a "self" parameter, with dynamic overload resolution. This |
---|
6242 | allows covariant method redefinition. However, if equality is |
---|
6243 | covariantly redefined for Point and ColoredPoint classes, and a |
---|
6244 | ColoredPoint is compared to a Point, Point equality will be used, |
---|
6245 | even if self is the colored point! |
---|
6246 | } |
---|
6247 | } |
---|
6248 | |
---|
6249 | @article{Dijkstra68b, |
---|
6250 | keywords = {semaphore, P/V}, |
---|
6251 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6252 | author = {E. W. Dijkstra}, |
---|
6253 | title = {The Structure of the ``{THE}''--Multiprogramming System}, |
---|
6254 | journal = cacm, |
---|
6255 | month = may, |
---|
6256 | year = 1968, |
---|
6257 | volume = 11, |
---|
6258 | number = 5, |
---|
6259 | pages = {341-346} |
---|
6260 | } |
---|
6261 | |
---|
6262 | @book{Holt78, |
---|
6263 | keywords = {operating systems, concurrency}, |
---|
6264 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6265 | author = {R. C. Holt and G. S. Graham and E. D. Lazowska and M. A. Scott}, |
---|
6266 | title = {Structured Concurrent Programming with Operating System Applications}, |
---|
6267 | publisher = {Addison-Wesley}, |
---|
6268 | address = {Boston}, |
---|
6269 | year = 1978, |
---|
6270 | } |
---|
6271 | |
---|
6272 | @article{Stevens74, |
---|
6273 | keywords = {coupling, cohesion}, |
---|
6274 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6275 | author = {W. P. Stevens and and G. J. Myers and L. L. Constantine}, |
---|
6276 | title = {Structured Design}, |
---|
6277 | journal = ibmsj, |
---|
6278 | year = 1974, |
---|
6279 | volume = 13, |
---|
6280 | number = 2, |
---|
6281 | pages = {115-139}, |
---|
6282 | } |
---|
6283 | |
---|
6284 | @article{Hansen72b, |
---|
6285 | keywords = {critical region}, |
---|
6286 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6287 | author = {Per {Brinch Hansen}}, |
---|
6288 | title = {Structured Multiprogramming}, |
---|
6289 | journal = cacm, |
---|
6290 | volume = 15, |
---|
6291 | number = 7, |
---|
6292 | month = jul, |
---|
6293 | year = 1972, |
---|
6294 | pages = {574-578}, |
---|
6295 | } |
---|
6296 | |
---|
6297 | @article{Knuth74, |
---|
6298 | keywords = {structured programming, goto statement}, |
---|
6299 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6300 | author = {Donald E. Knuth}, |
---|
6301 | title = {Structured Programming with go to Statements}, |
---|
6302 | journal = acmcs, |
---|
6303 | volume = 6, |
---|
6304 | number = 4, |
---|
6305 | month = dec, |
---|
6306 | year = 1974, |
---|
6307 | pages = {261-301}, |
---|
6308 | issn = {0360-0300}, |
---|
6309 | doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/356635.356640}, |
---|
6310 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
6311 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
6312 | } |
---|
6313 | |
---|
6314 | @article{Lang98, |
---|
6315 | keywords = {real-time, exception handling}, |
---|
6316 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6317 | author = {Jun Lang and David B. Stewart}, |
---|
6318 | title = {A Study of the Applicability of Existing Exception-Handling Techniques to Component-Based Real-Time Software Technology}, |
---|
6319 | journal = toplas, |
---|
6320 | month = mar, |
---|
6321 | year = 1998, |
---|
6322 | volume = 20, |
---|
6323 | number = 2, |
---|
6324 | pages = {274-301}, |
---|
6325 | } |
---|
6326 | |
---|
6327 | @mastersthesis{Fortier89, |
---|
6328 | keywords = {monitors}, |
---|
6329 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6330 | author = {Michel Fortier}, |
---|
6331 | title = {Study of Monitors}, |
---|
6332 | school = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo}, |
---|
6333 | year = 1989, |
---|
6334 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
6335 | } |
---|
6336 | |
---|
6337 | @techreport{AmadioCardelli, |
---|
6338 | keywords = {}, |
---|
6339 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6340 | author = {Roberto M. Amadio and Luca Cardelli}, |
---|
6341 | title = {Subtyping Recursive Types}, |
---|
6342 | institution = {Digital Equipment Corporation Systems Research Center}, |
---|
6343 | year = 1990, |
---|
6344 | address = {130 Lytton Avenue, Palo Alto, California 94301}, |
---|
6345 | month = aug, |
---|
6346 | number = 62, |
---|
6347 | summary = { |
---|
6348 | \[ (s \leq t \Rightarrow \alpha \leq \beta) \Rightarrow |
---|
6349 | \mu s.\alpha leq \mu t.\beta \] |
---|
6350 | \[ \alpha = C[\alpha] \and \beta = C[\beta] \and C contractive |
---|
6351 | \Rightarrow \alpha = \beta \] |
---|
6352 | where a type \(\alpha\) is contractive in the type variable \(t\) |
---|
6353 | if either \(t\) does not occur free in \(\alpha\), or \(\alpha\) |
---|
6354 | can be rewritten via unfolding as a type of the shape |
---|
6355 | \(\alpha_1 \rightarrow \alpha_2\), and unfolding rewrites |
---|
6356 | \(\mu t.\alpha\) as \([t\leftarrow\mu t.\alpha]\alpha\). An |
---|
6357 | algorithm for finding type contexts \(C\) is given. |
---|
6358 | } |
---|
6359 | } |
---|
6360 | |
---|
6361 | @techreport{Dijkstra80, |
---|
6362 | keywords = {split binary semaphores, general to binary}, |
---|
6363 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6364 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra}, |
---|
6365 | title = {The Superfluity of the General Semaphore}, |
---|
6366 | institution = {Nuenen}, |
---|
6367 | address = {Netherlands}, |
---|
6368 | number = {EWD734}, |
---|
6369 | month = apr, |
---|
6370 | year = 1980, |
---|
6371 | } |
---|
6372 | |
---|
6373 | @inproceedings{Burns81, |
---|
6374 | keywords = {N-thread software-solution mutual exclusion}, |
---|
6375 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6376 | author = {James E. Burns}, |
---|
6377 | title = {Symmetry in Systems of Asynchronous Processes}, |
---|
6378 | booktitle = {22nd Annual Symposium on Foundations of Computer Science, Nashville, TN, USA}, |
---|
6379 | year = 1981, |
---|
6380 | month = oct, |
---|
6381 | organization= {IEEE Computer Society}, |
---|
6382 | address = {Los Angeles, CA, USA}, |
---|
6383 | pages = {169-174}, |
---|
6384 | } |
---|
6385 | |
---|
6386 | @article{Coffman71, |
---|
6387 | keywords = {deadlock}, |
---|
6388 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6389 | author = {E. G. {Coffman, Jr.} and M. J. Elphick and A. Shoshani}, |
---|
6390 | title = {System Deadlocks}, |
---|
6391 | journal = acmcs, |
---|
6392 | volume = 3, |
---|
6393 | number = 2, |
---|
6394 | month = jun, |
---|
6395 | year = 1971, |
---|
6396 | pages = {67-78}, |
---|
6397 | publisher = {ACM Press}, |
---|
6398 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
6399 | doi = {http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/356586.356588}, |
---|
6400 | } |
---|
6401 | |
---|
6402 | @phdthesis{Holmes99, |
---|
6403 | keywords = {synchronization, inheritance anomaly}, |
---|
6404 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6405 | author = {David Holmes}, |
---|
6406 | title = {Synchronisation Rings: Composable Synchronisation for Object-Oriented Systems}, |
---|
6407 | school = {Department of Computing, Macquarie University}, |
---|
6408 | month = oct, |
---|
6409 | year = 1999, |
---|
6410 | address = {Sydney, Australia}, |
---|
6411 | } |
---|
6412 | |
---|
6413 | @book{Taubenfeld06, |
---|
6414 | keywords = {concurrency, synchronization}, |
---|
6415 | author = {Gadi Taubenfeld}, |
---|
6416 | title = {Synchronization Algorithms and Concurrent Programming}, |
---|
6417 | publisher = {Pearson/Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
6418 | address = {Harlow, England}, |
---|
6419 | year = 2006, |
---|
6420 | } |
---|
6421 | |
---|
6422 | @article{Buhr92b, |
---|
6423 | keywords = {concurrency, exception handling, interventions}, |
---|
6424 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6425 | author = {Peter A. Buhr and Hamish I. Macdonald and C. Robert Zarnke}, |
---|
6426 | title = {Synchronous and Asynchronous Handling of Abnormal Events in the $\mu${S}ystem}, |
---|
6427 | journal = spe, |
---|
6428 | volume = 22, |
---|
6429 | number = 9, |
---|
6430 | month = sep, |
---|
6431 | year = 1992, |
---|
6432 | pages = {735-776}, |
---|
6433 | } |
---|
6434 | |
---|
6435 | @inproceedings{Greenwald96, |
---|
6436 | keywords = {compare and swap, hardware atomicity}, |
---|
6437 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6438 | author = {Michael Greenwald and David Cheriton}, |
---|
6439 | title = {The Synergy between Non-blocking Synchronization and Operating System Structure}, |
---|
6440 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the Second USENIX Symposium on Operating Systems Design and Implementation}, |
---|
6441 | organization= {USENIX Association}, |
---|
6442 | address = {Seattle, Washington, U.S.A.}, |
---|
6443 | month = oct, |
---|
6444 | year = 1996, |
---|
6445 | pages = {123-136}, |
---|
6446 | } |
---|
6447 | |
---|
6448 | @inbook{SunLWP, |
---|
6449 | keywords = {light-weight processes, threads}, |
---|
6450 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6451 | key = {Sun}, |
---|
6452 | title = {System Services Overview, Lightweight Processes}, |
---|
6453 | chapter = {6}, |
---|
6454 | pages = {71-111}, |
---|
6455 | publisher = {Sun Microsystems}, |
---|
6456 | month = may, |
---|
6457 | year = 1988, |
---|
6458 | note = {available as Part Number: 800-1753-10}, |
---|
6459 | } |
---|
6460 | |
---|
6461 | @article{Randell75, |
---|
6462 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6463 | author = {Brian Randell}, |
---|
6464 | title = {System Structure for Software Fault Tolerance}, |
---|
6465 | journal = ieeese, |
---|
6466 | volume = {SE-1}, |
---|
6467 | number = 2, |
---|
6468 | month = jun, |
---|
6469 | year = 1975, |
---|
6470 | pages = {220-232}, |
---|
6471 | } |
---|
6472 | |
---|
6473 | @book{Modula-3, |
---|
6474 | keywords = {language reference manual}, |
---|
6475 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6476 | author = {Andrew Birrell and Mark R. Brown and Luca Cardelli and Jim Donahue and Lucille Glassman and John Gutag and Jim Harning and Bill Kalsow and Roy Levin and Greg Nelson}, |
---|
6477 | title = {Systems Programming with Modula-3}, |
---|
6478 | publisher = {Prentice-Hall}, |
---|
6479 | address = {Englewood Cliffs}, |
---|
6480 | year = 1991, |
---|
6481 | series = {Prentice-Hall Series in Innovative Technology} |
---|
6482 | } |
---|
6483 | |
---|
6484 | % T |
---|
6485 | |
---|
6486 | @article{Yeager91, |
---|
6487 | keywords = {teaching, concurrency}, |
---|
6488 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6489 | author = {Dorian P. Yeager}, |
---|
6490 | title = {Teaching Concurrency in the Programming Languages Course}, |
---|
6491 | journal = {SIGCSE BULLETIN}, |
---|
6492 | volume = 23, |
---|
6493 | number = 1, |
---|
6494 | month = mar, |
---|
6495 | year = 1991, |
---|
6496 | pages = {155-161}, |
---|
6497 | note = {The Papers of the Twenty-Second SIGCSE Technical Symposium on Computer Science Education, |
---|
6498 | March. 7--8, 1991, San Antonio, Texas, U.S.A.}, |
---|
6499 | } |
---|
6500 | |
---|
6501 | @article{ml, |
---|
6502 | keywords = {ML, polymorphism}, |
---|
6503 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6504 | author = {Robin Milner}, |
---|
6505 | title = {A Theory of Type Polymorphism in Programming}, |
---|
6506 | journal = jcss, |
---|
6507 | year = 1978, |
---|
6508 | volume = 17, pages = {348-375} |
---|
6509 | } |
---|
6510 | |
---|
6511 | @book{Thoth, |
---|
6512 | keywords = {messages, concurrency}, |
---|
6513 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6514 | author = {D. R. Cheriton}, |
---|
6515 | title = {The Thoth System: Multi-Process Structuring and Portability}, |
---|
6516 | publisher = {American Elsevier}, |
---|
6517 | year = 1982 |
---|
6518 | } |
---|
6519 | |
---|
6520 | @article{Boehm05, |
---|
6521 | keywords = {concurrency, C++}, |
---|
6522 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6523 | author = {Hans-J. Boehm}, |
---|
6524 | title = {Threads Cannot be Implemented as a Library}, |
---|
6525 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
6526 | volume = 40, |
---|
6527 | number = 6, |
---|
6528 | month = jun, |
---|
6529 | year = 2005, |
---|
6530 | pages = {261-268}, |
---|
6531 | } |
---|
6532 | |
---|
6533 | @misc{Bumbulis90, |
---|
6534 | keywords = {parameter inference, ForceN}, |
---|
6535 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6536 | author = {Peter Bumbulis}, |
---|
6537 | title = {Towards Making Signatures First-Class}, |
---|
6538 | howpublished= {personal communication}, |
---|
6539 | month = sep, year = 1990, |
---|
6540 | note = {} |
---|
6541 | } |
---|
6542 | |
---|
6543 | @techreport{alphard:preempt, |
---|
6544 | keywords = {}, |
---|
6545 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6546 | author = {Mary Shaw and Wm. A. Wulf}, |
---|
6547 | title = {Toward Relaxing Assumptions in Languages and Their Implementations}, |
---|
6548 | institution = {Carnegie-Mellon University}, |
---|
6549 | year = 1980, |
---|
6550 | month = jan, |
---|
6551 | note = {Reprinted in \cite{alphard}.} |
---|
6552 | } |
---|
6553 | |
---|
6554 | @inproceedings{Reynolds74, |
---|
6555 | keywords = {universal quantification, typed lambda calculus}, |
---|
6556 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6557 | author = {John C. Reynolds}, |
---|
6558 | title = {Towards a Theory of Type Structure}, |
---|
6559 | booktitle = {Colloque sur la Programmation}, |
---|
6560 | year = 1974, |
---|
6561 | pages = {408-423}, |
---|
6562 | editor = {B. Robinet}, |
---|
6563 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
6564 | note = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science, v. 19}, |
---|
6565 | abstract = { |
---|
6566 | |
---|
6567 | } |
---|
6568 | } |
---|
6569 | |
---|
6570 | @incollection{Hoare72, |
---|
6571 | keywords = {critical region, concurrency}, |
---|
6572 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6573 | author = {C. A. R. Hoare}, |
---|
6574 | title = {Towards a Theory of Parallel Programming}, |
---|
6575 | booktitle = {Operating Systems Techniques}, |
---|
6576 | editor = {C. A. R. Hoare and R. H. Perott}, |
---|
6577 | publisher = {Academic Press, New York}, |
---|
6578 | year = 1972, |
---|
6579 | pages = {61-71}, |
---|
6580 | } |
---|
6581 | |
---|
6582 | @inproceedings{Mitchell90, |
---|
6583 | keywords = {polymorphism, lambda calculus, bounded quantification}, |
---|
6584 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6585 | author = {John C. Mitchell}, |
---|
6586 | title = {Toward a Typed Foundation for Method Specialization and Inheritance}, |
---|
6587 | booktitle = {Conference Record of the Seventeenth Annual ACM Symposium |
---|
6588 | on Principles of Programming Languages}, |
---|
6589 | year = 1990, |
---|
6590 | month = jan, pages = {109-124}, |
---|
6591 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery}, |
---|
6592 | abstract = { |
---|
6593 | This paper disucsses the phenomenon of {\em method specialization} |
---|
6594 | in object-oriented programming languages. A typed function |
---|
6595 | calculus of objects and classes is presented, featuring method |
---|
6596 | specialization when methods are added or redefined. The soundness |
---|
6597 | of the typing rules (without subtyping) is suggested by a |
---|
6598 | translation into a more traditional calculus with |
---|
6599 | recursively-defined record types. However, semantic questions |
---|
6600 | regarding the subtype relation on classes remain open. |
---|
6601 | } |
---|
6602 | } |
---|
6603 | |
---|
6604 | @article{EL1, |
---|
6605 | keywords = {polymorphism}, |
---|
6606 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6607 | author = {B. Wegbreit}, |
---|
6608 | title = {The Treatment of Data Types in {EL1}}, |
---|
6609 | journal = cacm, |
---|
6610 | volume = 17, |
---|
6611 | number = 5, |
---|
6612 | month = may, |
---|
6613 | year = 1974, |
---|
6614 | pages = {251-264}, |
---|
6615 | } |
---|
6616 | |
---|
6617 | @mastersthesis{Till89, |
---|
6618 | keywords = {C, multiple return values, tuples}, |
---|
6619 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6620 | author = {David W. Till}, |
---|
6621 | title = {Tuples In Imperative Programming Languages}, |
---|
6622 | school = {Department of Computer Science, University of Waterloo}, |
---|
6623 | year = 1989, |
---|
6624 | address = {Waterloo, Ontario, Canada, N2L 3G1}, |
---|
6625 | } |
---|
6626 | |
---|
6627 | @article{turing:old, |
---|
6628 | keywords = {verification, context conditions, faithful execution}, |
---|
6629 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6630 | author = {R. C. Holt and J. R. Cordy}, |
---|
6631 | title = {The Turing Programming Language}, |
---|
6632 | journal = cacm, |
---|
6633 | year = 1988, |
---|
6634 | month = dec, |
---|
6635 | volume = 31, number = 12, pages = {1410-1423} |
---|
6636 | } |
---|
6637 | |
---|
6638 | @book{Turing, |
---|
6639 | keywords = {verification, context conditions, faithful execution}, |
---|
6640 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6641 | author = {R. C. Holt}, |
---|
6642 | title = {Turing Reference Manual}, |
---|
6643 | publisher = {Holt Software Associates Inc.}, |
---|
6644 | year = 1992, |
---|
6645 | edition = {3rd}, |
---|
6646 | } |
---|
6647 | |
---|
6648 | @techreport{Dijkstra79, |
---|
6649 | keywords = {split binary semaphores}, |
---|
6650 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6651 | author = {Edsger W. Dijkstra}, |
---|
6652 | title = {A Tutorial on the Split Binary Semaphore}, |
---|
6653 | institution = {Nuenen}, |
---|
6654 | address = {Netherlands}, |
---|
6655 | number = {EWD703}, |
---|
6656 | month = mar, |
---|
6657 | year = 1979, |
---|
6658 | } |
---|
6659 | |
---|
6660 | @book{pldesign, |
---|
6661 | keywords = {}, |
---|
6662 | editor = {Anthony I. Wasserman}, |
---|
6663 | title = {Tutorial: Programming Language Design}, |
---|
6664 | publisher = {Computer Society Press}, |
---|
6665 | address = {Los Alamitos}, |
---|
6666 | year = 1980 |
---|
6667 | } |
---|
6668 | |
---|
6669 | @article{Leroy00, |
---|
6670 | keywords = {type-systems, exceptions}, |
---|
6671 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6672 | author = {Xavier Leroy and Fran\c{c}ois Pessaux}, |
---|
6673 | title = {Type-Based Analysis of Uncaught Exceptions}, |
---|
6674 | journal = toplas, |
---|
6675 | month = mar, |
---|
6676 | year = 2000, |
---|
6677 | volume = 22, |
---|
6678 | number = 2, |
---|
6679 | pages = {340-377}, |
---|
6680 | comment = { |
---|
6681 | Argues against declaring exceptions on routine definitions. |
---|
6682 | }, |
---|
6683 | } |
---|
6684 | |
---|
6685 | @article{Cormack90, |
---|
6686 | keywords = {polymorphism}, |
---|
6687 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6688 | author = {G. V. Cormack and A. K. Wright}, |
---|
6689 | title = {Type-dependent Parameter Inference}, |
---|
6690 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
6691 | volume = 25, |
---|
6692 | number = 6, |
---|
6693 | month = jun, |
---|
6694 | year = 1990, |
---|
6695 | pages = {127-136}, |
---|
6696 | note = {Proceedings of the ACM Sigplan'90 Conference on Programming Language Design and Implementation |
---|
6697 | June 20-22, 1990, White Plains, New York, U.S.A.}, |
---|
6698 | } |
---|
6699 | |
---|
6700 | @article{concatenation, |
---|
6701 | keywords = {record concatenation, isa}, |
---|
6702 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6703 | author = {N. Wirth}, |
---|
6704 | title = {Type Extensions}, |
---|
6705 | journal = toplas, |
---|
6706 | volume = {10}, |
---|
6707 | number = {2}, |
---|
6708 | pages = {204-214}, |
---|
6709 | month = apr, year = 1988, |
---|
6710 | comment = { |
---|
6711 | Extended record types add fields to their base record. Assignment |
---|
6712 | truncations. Pointers can point at extended type instances. For |
---|
6713 | polymorphism, call by value is assignment, and call by reference is |
---|
6714 | pointer passing. Overloading isn't discussed. Type information |
---|
6715 | can be recovered through an ``is'' type test or through type guards |
---|
6716 | (casts). A version of the WITH statement could avoid repeated |
---|
6717 | checking. |
---|
6718 | |
---|
6719 | Private/public access to record fields can be provided by exporting |
---|
6720 | a base type, and using a private extension. Statically allocated |
---|
6721 | instances need a compiler hint specifying the maximum size of the |
---|
6722 | private type. |
---|
6723 | |
---|
6724 | Type checking is cheap (if the creation of pointer values is |
---|
6725 | controlled). Types have type descriptors. Extension descriptors |
---|
6726 | point at their direct base. Heap objects point at their |
---|
6727 | descriptor, and reference parameters are accompanied by type |
---|
6728 | descriptor parameters. ``v is t0'' loops along the chain of |
---|
6729 | descriptors. |
---|
6730 | } |
---|
6731 | } |
---|
6732 | |
---|
6733 | % U |
---|
6734 | |
---|
6735 | @book{uC++book, |
---|
6736 | keywords = {control structure, concurrency, uC++}, |
---|
6737 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6738 | author = {Peter A. Buhr}, |
---|
6739 | title = {Understanding Control Flow: Concurrent Programming using $\mu${C}{\kern-.1em\hbox{\large\texttt{+\kern-.25em+}}}}, |
---|
6740 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
6741 | address = {Switzerland}, |
---|
6742 | year = 2016, |
---|
6743 | } |
---|
6744 | |
---|
6745 | @article{Cardelli85, |
---|
6746 | keywords = {polymorphism}, |
---|
6747 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6748 | author = {Luca Cardelli and Peter Wegner}, |
---|
6749 | title = {On Understanding Types, Data Abstractions, and Polymorphism}, |
---|
6750 | journal = acmcs, |
---|
6751 | month = dec, |
---|
6752 | year = 1985, |
---|
6753 | volume = 17, |
---|
6754 | number = 4, |
---|
6755 | pages = {471-522}, |
---|
6756 | } |
---|
6757 | |
---|
6758 | @inproceedings{Wilson92, |
---|
6759 | keywords = {garbage collection survey}, |
---|
6760 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6761 | author = {Paul R. Wilson}, |
---|
6762 | title = {Uniprocessor Garbage Collection Techniques}, |
---|
6763 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the International Workshop on Memory Management}, |
---|
6764 | location = {St. Malo, France}, |
---|
6765 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
6766 | series = {Lecture Notes in Computer Science}, |
---|
6767 | volume = 637, |
---|
6768 | month = sep, |
---|
6769 | year = {1992}, |
---|
6770 | pages = {1-42}, |
---|
6771 | } |
---|
6772 | |
---|
6773 | @inproceedings{Hewitt73, |
---|
6774 | author = {Carl Hewitt and Peter Bishop and Richard Steiger}, |
---|
6775 | title = {A Universal Modular {ACTOR} Formalism for Artificial Intelligence}, |
---|
6776 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the 3rd International Joint Conference on Artificial Intelligence}, |
---|
6777 | address = {Standford, California, U.S.A.}, |
---|
6778 | pages = {235-245}, |
---|
6779 | month = aug, |
---|
6780 | year = 1973, |
---|
6781 | } |
---|
6782 | |
---|
6783 | @article{Bourne78, |
---|
6784 | keywords = {Shell}, |
---|
6785 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6786 | author = {S. R. Bourne}, |
---|
6787 | title = {The UNIX Shell}, |
---|
6788 | journal = {The Bell System Technical Journal}, |
---|
6789 | volume = {57, part 2}, |
---|
6790 | month = {July--August}, |
---|
6791 | year = 1978, |
---|
6792 | pages = {1971-1990}, |
---|
6793 | } |
---|
6794 | |
---|
6795 | @inproceedings{Krischer12, |
---|
6796 | keywords = {exception, usability, asynchronous, assertion, injection, logging}, |
---|
6797 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6798 | author = {Roy Krischer and Peter A. Buhr}, |
---|
6799 | title = {Usability Challenges in Exception Handling}, |
---|
6800 | booktitle = {5th International Workshop on Exception Handling (WEH)}, |
---|
6801 | organization= {16th International Symposium on the Foundations of Software Engineering (FSE 16)}, |
---|
6802 | address = {Zurich, Switzerland}, |
---|
6803 | month = jun, |
---|
6804 | year = 2012, |
---|
6805 | pages = {7-13}, |
---|
6806 | } |
---|
6807 | |
---|
6808 | @techreport{Harmony, |
---|
6809 | keywords = {messages, concurrency}, |
---|
6810 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6811 | author = {W. Morven Gentleman}, |
---|
6812 | title = {Using the Harmony Operating System}, |
---|
6813 | institution = {National Research Council of Canada, Ottawa, Canada}, |
---|
6814 | number = {24685}, |
---|
6815 | month = may, |
---|
6816 | year = 1985 |
---|
6817 | } |
---|
6818 | |
---|
6819 | @article{delegation, |
---|
6820 | keywords = {delegation, inheritance, actors}, |
---|
6821 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6822 | author = {Henry Lieverman}, |
---|
6823 | title = {Using Prototypical Objects to Implement Shared Behavior in |
---|
6824 | Object Oriented Systems}, |
---|
6825 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
6826 | month = nov, year = 1986, |
---|
6827 | volume = 21, number = 11, pages = {214-223} |
---|
6828 | } |
---|
6829 | |
---|
6830 | % V |
---|
6831 | |
---|
6832 | @article{V-Kernel, |
---|
6833 | keywords = {messages, concurrency}, |
---|
6834 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6835 | author = {David R. Cheriton}, |
---|
6836 | title = {The {V} Distributed System}, |
---|
6837 | journal = cacm, |
---|
6838 | month = mar, |
---|
6839 | year = 1988, |
---|
6840 | volume = 31, |
---|
6841 | number = 3, |
---|
6842 | pages = {314-333} |
---|
6843 | } |
---|
6844 | |
---|
6845 | @inproceedings{Amdahl67, |
---|
6846 | author = {Gene M. Amdahl}, |
---|
6847 | title = {Validity of the Single Processor Approach to Achieving Large Scale Computing Capabilities}, |
---|
6848 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the April 18-20, 1967, Spring Joint Computer Conference}, |
---|
6849 | series = {AFIPS '67 (Spring)}, |
---|
6850 | year = 1967, |
---|
6851 | location = {Atlantic City, New Jersey}, |
---|
6852 | pages = {483--485}, |
---|
6853 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
6854 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
6855 | } |
---|
6856 | |
---|
6857 | @article{Mayer81, |
---|
6858 | keywords = {}, |
---|
6859 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6860 | author = {A. J. W. Mayer}, |
---|
6861 | title = {Value Receiving Procedures}, |
---|
6862 | journal = sigplan, |
---|
6863 | volume = 16, |
---|
6864 | number = 11, |
---|
6865 | month = nov, |
---|
6866 | year = 1981, |
---|
6867 | pages = {30-34}, |
---|
6868 | } |
---|
6869 | |
---|
6870 | @article{Doran80, |
---|
6871 | keywords = {concurrency, Dekker's Algorithm}, |
---|
6872 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6873 | author = {R. W. Doran and L. K. Thomas}, |
---|
6874 | title = {Variants of the Software Solution to Mutual Exclusion}, |
---|
6875 | journal = ipl, |
---|
6876 | month = jul, |
---|
6877 | year = 1980, |
---|
6878 | volume = 10, |
---|
6879 | number = {4/5}, |
---|
6880 | pages = {206-208}, |
---|
6881 | } |
---|
6882 | |
---|
6883 | @book{VAX, |
---|
6884 | keywords = {VAX, DEC}, |
---|
6885 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6886 | key = {VAX}, |
---|
6887 | title = {VAX-11 Architecture Reference Manual}, |
---|
6888 | publisher = {Digital Press}, |
---|
6889 | address = {Bedford}, |
---|
6890 | month = may, |
---|
6891 | year = 1982, |
---|
6892 | } |
---|
6893 | |
---|
6894 | @book{Kenah88, |
---|
6895 | author = {Lawrence J. Kenah and Ruth E. Goldenberg and Simon F. Bate}, |
---|
6896 | title = {{VAX/VMS} Internals and Data Structures Version 4.4}, |
---|
6897 | publisher = {Digital Press}, |
---|
6898 | address = {Bedford}, |
---|
6899 | year = 1988, |
---|
6900 | } |
---|
6901 | |
---|
6902 | @article{Hesselink13, |
---|
6903 | keywords = {software solutions, N-thread, mutual exclusions}, |
---|
6904 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6905 | author = {Wim H. Hesselink}, |
---|
6906 | title = {Verifying a Simplification of Mutual Exclusion by {L}ycklama--{H}adzilacos}, |
---|
6907 | journal = {Acta Informatica}, |
---|
6908 | publisher = {Springer}, |
---|
6909 | address = {New York}, |
---|
6910 | year = {2013}, |
---|
6911 | volume = {50}, |
---|
6912 | number = {3}, |
---|
6913 | pages = {199-228}, |
---|
6914 | } |
---|
6915 | |
---|
6916 | % W |
---|
6917 | |
---|
6918 | @article{Herlihy91, |
---|
6919 | keywords = {linearization, wait-free synchronization}, |
---|
6920 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6921 | author = {Maurice Herlihy}, |
---|
6922 | title = {Wait-free Synchronization}, |
---|
6923 | journal = toplas, |
---|
6924 | volume = {13}, |
---|
6925 | number = {1}, |
---|
6926 | month = jan, |
---|
6927 | year = 1991, |
---|
6928 | pages = {124--149}, |
---|
6929 | numpages = {26}, |
---|
6930 | publisher = {ACM}, |
---|
6931 | address = {New York, NY, USA}, |
---|
6932 | } |
---|
6933 | |
---|
6934 | @techreport{Moss90, |
---|
6935 | keywords = {Swizzling, database}, |
---|
6936 | contributer = {akgoel@plg}, |
---|
6937 | author = {J. Moss}, |
---|
6938 | title = {Working with Persistent Objects: To Swizzle or Not to Swizzle}, |
---|
6939 | institution = {CS Department, University of Massachusetts}, |
---|
6940 | address = {}, |
---|
6941 | number = {CS 90-38}, |
---|
6942 | month = may, |
---|
6943 | year = 1990, |
---|
6944 | } |
---|
6945 | |
---|
6946 | @inproceedings{Str:oop, |
---|
6947 | keywords = { }, |
---|
6948 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6949 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
6950 | title = {What is ``Object-Oriented Programming''?}, |
---|
6951 | booktitle = {Proceedings of the First European Conference on Object Oriented Programming}, |
---|
6952 | month = jun, |
---|
6953 | year = 1987 |
---|
6954 | } |
---|
6955 | |
---|
6956 | @misc{Stroustrup:overloading, |
---|
6957 | keywords = {operator overloading}, |
---|
6958 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6959 | author = {Bjarne Stroustrup}, |
---|
6960 | title = {Why can't I overload dot, ::, sizeof, etc.?}, |
---|
6961 | month = oct, |
---|
6962 | year = 2007, |
---|
6963 | howpublished= {{\small\textsf{http://\-www.research.att.com/\-bs/\-bs\_faq2.html\-\#overload-dot}}}, |
---|
6964 | } |
---|
6965 | |
---|
6966 | @techreport{Gray85, |
---|
6967 | keywords = {fault-tolerant system}, |
---|
6968 | contributer = {pabuhr@plg}, |
---|
6969 | author = {Jim Gray}, |
---|
6970 | title = {Why Do Computers Stop and What Can Be Done About It?}, |
---|
6971 | institution = {Tandem Computers}, |
---|
6972 | number = {85.7 PN87614}, |
---|
6973 | month = jun, |
---|
6974 | year = 1985, |
---|
6975 | note = {\href{http://www.hpl.hp.com/techreports/tandem/TR-85.7.pdf}{http://www.hpl.hp.com/\-techreports/\-tandem/\-TR-85.7.pdf}}, |
---|
6976 | } |
---|
6977 | |
---|
6978 | % X |
---|
6979 | |
---|
6980 | % Y |
---|
6981 | |
---|
6982 | % Z |
---|
6983 | |
---|
6984 | % Cross-referenced entries: |
---|
6985 | |
---|
6986 | % O |
---|
6987 | |
---|
6988 | % The SIGPLAN Notices issue should be in a note field, but notes are |
---|
6989 | % inherited by all refering entries, instead of being held in the |
---|
6990 | % cross-referenced entry. Putting it in "publisher" is a kludge, but it |
---|
6991 | % works. |
---|
6992 | @proceedings{OOPSLA86, |
---|
6993 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
6994 | title = {{OOPSLA} '86 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
6995 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '86 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
6996 | year = 1986, |
---|
6997 | editor = {Norman Meyrowitz}, |
---|
6998 | publisher = sigplan # " 21(11)", |
---|
6999 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery}, |
---|
7000 | address = {Portland, Oregon}, |
---|
7001 | month = sep # { 29} |
---|
7002 | } |
---|
7003 | |
---|
7004 | @proceedings{OOPSLA87, |
---|
7005 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
7006 | title = {{OOPSLA} '87 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
7007 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '87 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
7008 | year = 1987, |
---|
7009 | editor = {Norman Meyrowitz}, |
---|
7010 | publisher = sigplan # " 22(12)", |
---|
7011 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery}, |
---|
7012 | address = {Orlando, Florida}, |
---|
7013 | month = oct # { 4--8} |
---|
7014 | } |
---|
7015 | |
---|
7016 | @proceedings{OOPSLA88, |
---|
7017 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
7018 | title = {{OOPSLA} '88 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
7019 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '88 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
7020 | year = 1988, |
---|
7021 | editor = {Norman Meyrowitz}, |
---|
7022 | publisher = sigplan # " 23(11)", |
---|
7023 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery}, |
---|
7024 | address = {San Diego, California}, |
---|
7025 | month = sep # { 25--30} |
---|
7026 | } |
---|
7027 | |
---|
7028 | @proceedings{OOPSLA89, |
---|
7029 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
7030 | title = {{OOPSLA} '89 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
7031 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '89 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
7032 | year = 1989, |
---|
7033 | editor = {Norman Meyrowitz}, |
---|
7034 | publisher = sigplan # " 24(10)", |
---|
7035 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery}, |
---|
7036 | address = {New Orleans, Louisiana}, |
---|
7037 | month = oct # { 1--6} |
---|
7038 | } |
---|
7039 | |
---|
7040 | @proceedings{OOPSLA90, |
---|
7041 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
7042 | title = {{OOPSLA/ECOOP} '90 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
7043 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '90 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
7044 | year = 1990, |
---|
7045 | editor = {Norman Meyrowitz}, |
---|
7046 | publisher = sigplan # " 25(10)", |
---|
7047 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery}, |
---|
7048 | address = {Ottawa, Canada}, |
---|
7049 | month = oct # { 21--25} |
---|
7050 | } |
---|
7051 | |
---|
7052 | @proceedings{OOPSLA91, |
---|
7053 | contributer = {gjditchfield@plg}, |
---|
7054 | title = {{OOPSLA} '91 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
7055 | booktitle = {{OOPSLA} '91 Conference Proceedings}, |
---|
7056 | year = 1991, |
---|
7057 | editor = {Andreas Paepcke}, |
---|
7058 | publisher = sigplan # " 26(11)", |
---|
7059 | organization= {Association for Computing Machinery}, |
---|
7060 | address = {Phoenix, Arizona}, |
---|
7061 | month = oct # { 6--11} |
---|
7062 | } |
---|